sterling_10k-123112.htm


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
FORM 10-K
Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
 
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2012                                     Commission File No. 1-5273-1
 
STERLING BANCORP
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 
New York   13-2565216
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)   (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
     
650 Fifth Avenue, New York, N.Y.   10019-6108
(Address of principal executive offices)   (Zip Code)
 
(212) 757-3300
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
 
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(B) OF THE ACT:
 
TITLE OF EACH CLASS
NAME OF EACH EXCHANGE ON WHICH REGISTERED
Common Shares, $1 par value per share
New York Stock Exchange
Cumulative Trust Preferred
 
Securities 8.375% (Liquidation Amount
$10 per Preferred Security) of Sterling
Bancorp Trust I and Guarantee of Sterling
Bancorp with respect thereto
New York Stock Exchange
 
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(G) OF THE ACT: NONE
 
Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes [ ]  No [ü]
 
Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  Yes [ ]  No [ü]
 
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes [ü]  No [ ]
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes [ü]  No [ ]
 
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. [ü]
 
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):
Large Accelerated Filer [ ] Accelerated Filer [ü] Non-Accelerated Filer [ ]  Smaller Reporting Company [ ]
 
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes [ ]  No [ü]
 
On June 30, 2012, the aggregate market value of the common equity held by non-affiliates of the Registrant was $293,568,746.
 
The Registrant has one class of common shares, of which 30,955,796 shares were outstanding at February 15, 2013.
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
 
(1) Portions of Sterling Bancorp’s definitive Proxy Statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A are incorporated by reference in Part III.
 
 
 

 
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
   
Page
 
PART I
 
Item 1.
BUSINESS
1
Item 1A.
RISK FACTORS
15
Item 1B.
UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
26
Item 2.
PROPERTIES
26
Item 3.
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
26
Item 4.
MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
27
Item 4A.
SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS
27
     
 
PART II
 
Item 5.
MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
27
Item 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
28
Item 7.
MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
28
Item 7A.
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
28
Item 8.
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
56
Item 9.
CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
114
Item 9A.
CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
114
Item 9B.
OTHER INFORMATION
116
     
 
PART III
 
Item 10.
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
117
Item 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
117
Item 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
117
Item 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
117
Item 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
117
     
 
PART IV
 
Item 15.
EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
118
SIGNATURES
121
Exhibits Submitted in a Separate Volume.
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
PART I
 
ITEM 1. BUSINESS
 
The disclosures set forth in this item are qualified by ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS on pages 15–26 and the section captioned “FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS AND FACTORS THAT COULD AFFECT FUTURE RESULTS” on page 30 and other cautionary statements set forth elsewhere in this report.
 
Sterling Bancorp (the “parent company” or the “Registrant”) is a bank holding company and a financial holding company as defined by the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHCA”), which was organized in 1966. Sterling Bancorp and its subsidiaries derive substantially all of their revenue and income from providing banking and related financial services and products to customers primarily in New York, New Jersey and Connecticut (the “New York metropolitan area”). Throughout this report, the terms the “Company” or “Sterling” refer to Sterling Bancorp and its consolidated subsidiaries, while the terms the “parent company” or the “Registrant” refer to Sterling Bancorp but not its subsidiaries. The Company has operations in the New York metropolitan area and conducts business throughout the United States.
 
The parent company owns, directly or indirectly, all of the outstanding shares of Sterling National Bank (the “bank”), its principal subsidiary, and all of the outstanding shares of Sterling Banking Corporation and Sterling Bancorp Trust I (the “trust”). Sterling National Mortgage Company, Inc. (“SNMC”), Sterling Factors Corporation (“Factors”), Sterling Resource Funding Corp. (“Resource Funding”) and Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. are wholly-owned subsidiaries of the bank. The operations of SNMC, Factors and Resource Funding were merged into the bank as of July 1, 2011, October 1, 2011 and January 1, 2012, respectively. These actions were taken to simplify marketing and business development efforts, present a unified service offering to customers and streamline organizational structure.
 
Although Sterling Bancorp is a corporate entity, legally separate and distinct from its affiliates, bank holding companies such as Sterling Bancorp are generally required to act as a source of financial strength for their subsidiary banks. The principal source of Sterling Bancorp’s income is dividends from its subsidiaries. There are certain regulatory restrictions on the extent to which these subsidiaries can pay dividends or otherwise supply funds to Sterling Bancorp. See the section captioned “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” for further discussion of these matters.
 
During the latter half of 2011, the Company combined its operating segments into one reportable segment, “Community Banking.” All of the Company’s activities are interrelated, and each activity is dependent and assessed based on the manner in which it supports the other activities of the Company. For example, lending is dependent upon the ability of the bank to fund itself with retail deposits and other borrowings and to manage interest rate and credit risk. Accordingly, all significant operating decisions are based upon analysis of the Company as one operating segment or unit. The Company derives a substantial portion of its revenue and income from providing banking and related financial services and products to customers located primarily in the New York metropolitan area. The financial information in this report reflects the single segment through which the Company conducts its business.
 
BUSINESS OPERATIONS
 
The Bank
Sterling National Bank was organized in 1929 under the National Bank Act and commenced operations in New York City. The bank maintains fourteen offices in New York: eleven offices in New York City (six branches and an international banking facility in Manhattan and four branches in Queens); two branches in Nassau County (one in Great Neck and the other in Woodbury, New York) and one branch in Yonkers, New York. The executive office is located at 650 Fifth Avenue, New York, New York.
 
The bank provides a broad range of banking and financial products and services, including business and consumer lending, asset-based financing, residential mortgage warehouse funding, factoring/accounts receivable management services, equipment financing, commercial and resi­dential mortgage lending and brokerage, deposit services, and trade financing.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2012, the bank’s average earning assets represented approximately 99.3% of the Company’s average earning assets. Loans represented 65.7% and investment securities represented 31.5% of the bank’s average earning assets in 2012.
 
 
PAGE 1

 
 
Commercial Lending, Asset-Based Financing, Residential Mortgage Warehouse Funding, and Factoring/Accounts Receivable Management. The bank provides loans to small and medium-sized businesses. The businesses are diversified across industries, including commercial, industrial and financial companies, and government and non-profit entities. Loans generally range in size up to $20 million and can be tailored to meet customers’ specific long- and short-term needs, and include secured and unsecured lines of credit, business installment loans, business lines of credit, and debtor-in-possession financing. Loans are often collateralized by assets, such as accounts receivable, inventory, marketable securities, other liquid collateral, equipment and other assets.
 
The bank provides financing and human resource business ­process outsourcing support services, exclusively for the temporary staffing industry. The bank provides full back-office, computer, tax and accounting services, as well as financing, to independently-owned staffing companies located throughout the United States. The average contract term is 18 months for approximately 241 staffing companies.
 
The bank offers residential mortgage warehouse funding services to mortgage bankers. Such funding consists of a line of credit (a “warehouse line”) used by the mortgage banker as a form of temporary financing during the period between the closing of a mortgage loan until its sale into the secondary market, which period typically lasts from 15 to 30 days. The bank provides warehouse lines in amounts ranging from $5 million to $30 million to an approved client base, which as of December 31, 2012, consisted of approximately 21 mortgage bankers operating nationally. The warehouse lines are secured by high quality first mortgage loans, which include conventional FannieMae and FreddieMac, jumbo and FHA loans.
 
The bank provides accounts receivable management services. The purchase of a client’s accounts receivable is traditionally known as “factoring” and results in payment by the client of a nonrefundable factoring fee, which is generally a percentage of the factored receivables or sales volume and is designed to compensate for the bookkeeping and collection services provided and, if applicable, its credit review of the client’s customer and assumption of customer credit risk. When the bank “factors” (i.e., purchases) an account receivable from a client, it records the receivable as an asset (included in “Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts”), records a liability for the funds due to the client (included in “noninterest-bearing demand deposits”) and credits to noninterest income the nonrefundable factoring fee (included in “Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees”). The bank also may advance funds to its client prior to the collection of receivables, charging interest on such advances (in addition to any factoring fees) and normally satisfying such advances by the collection of receivables. The accounts receivable factored are primarily for clients engaged in the apparel and textile industries.
 
As of December 31, 2012, the outstanding loan balance (net of unearned discounts) for commercial and industrial lending, asset-based financing, residential mortgage warehouse funding and factored receivables was $1,128.2 million, representing approximately 64.1% of the bank’s total loan portfolio.
 
There are no industry concentrations in the commercial and industrial loan portfolio that exceed 10% of gross loans. Approximately 67% of the bank’s loans are to borrowers located in the New York metropolitan area. The bank has no foreign loans.
 
Equipment Financing. The bank offers equipment financing services in the New York metropolitan area and across the United States through direct leasing programs, third-party sources and vendor programs. The bank finances full payout leases for various types of business equipment, written on a recourse basis—with personal guarantees of the principals, with terms generally ranging from 24 to 60 months. At December 31, 2012, the outstanding balance (net of unearned discounts) for equipment financing receivables was $162.1 million, with a remaining average term of 35 months, representing approximately 9.2% of the bank’s total loan portfolio.
 
Residential and Commercial Mortgages. The bank’s real estate loan portfolio consists of real estate loans on one-to-four family residential properties, multi-family residential properties and nonresidential commercial properties. The residential mortgage banking and brokerage business is conducted through offices located principally in New York. Residential mortgage loans, substantially all of which are for single-family residences, are focused on conforming credit, government insured FHA and other high-quality loan products and are originated primarily in the New York metropolitan area, Virginia and other mid-Atlantic states, almost all of these for resale. In addition, the Company retains in portfolio fixed and floating rate residential mortgage loans, primarily on properties located in the New York metropolitan area, which were originated by its mortgage banking division. Commercial real estate lending, including financing on multi-family residential properties and nonresidential commercial properties, is offered on income-producing investor properties and owner-occupied properties, professional co-ops and condos. At December 31, 2012, the outstanding loan balance for real estate mortgage loans was $455.6 million, representing approximately 25.9% of the bank’s total loans outstanding.
 
 
PAGE 2

 
 
Deposit Services. The bank attracts deposits from customers located primarily in the New York metropolitan area, offering a broad array of deposit products, including checking accounts, money market accounts, negotiable order of withdrawal (“NOW”) accounts, savings accounts, rent security accounts, retirement accounts, and certificates of deposit. The bank’s deposit services include account management and information, disbursement, reconciliation, collection and concentration, ACH and others designed for specific business purposes. The deposits of the bank are insured to the extent permitted by law pursuant to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended.
 
Trade Finance. Through its international division and international banking facility, the bank offers financial services to its customers and correspondents in the world’s major financial centers. These services consist of financing import and export transactions, issuing letters of credit, processing documentary collections and creating banker’s acceptances. In addition, active bank account relationships are maintained with leading foreign banking institutions in major financial centers.
 
Foreign activities of the Company are not considered to be material with predominantly all revenues and assets attributable to customers located in the United States. As of December 31, 2012, there were no loans to or deposits from customers located outside the United States.
 
The composition of total revenues (interest income and noninterest income) of the bank and its subsidiaries for the three most recent fiscal years was as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Interest and fees on loans
    58 %     54 %     51 %
Interest and dividends on investment securities
    14       17       18  
Noninterest income
    28       29       31  
      100 %     100 %     100 %
 
At December 31, 2012, the Company had 553 full-time equivalent employees, consisting of 259 officers and 294 supervisory and clerical employees. The bank considers its relations with its employees to be satisfactory.
 
COMPETITION
 
There is intense competition in all areas in which the Company conducts its business. As a result of the deregulation of the financial services industry under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, the Company competes with banks and other financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings banks, finance companies, and credit unions. Many of these competitors have substantially greater resources and may have higher lending limits and provide a wider array of banking services than the Company does. To a limited extent, the Company also competes with other providers of financial services, such as money market mutual funds, brokerage firms, consumer finance companies and insurance companies. The Company generally competes on the basis of level of customer service, responsiveness to customer needs, availability and pricing of products, and geographic location.
 
SUPERVISION AND REGULATION
 
General
The banking industry is highly regulated. Statutory and regulatory controls are designed primarily for the protection of depositors and the banking system, and not for the purpose of protecting the shareholders of the parent company. The following discussion is not intended to be a complete list of all the activities regulated by the banking laws or of the impact of such laws and regulations on the bank and the Company. It is intended only to briefly summarize some material provisions. Changes in applicable law or regulation, and in their interpretation and application by regulatory agencies, cannot be predicted, but they may have a material effect on the business results, and condition of the Company.
 
The parent company is a bank holding company and a financial holding company under the BHCA and is subject to supervision, examination and reporting requirements of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve Board”). Sterling is also subject to the disclosure and regulatory requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), as administered by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). Sterling Bancorp is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) under the trading symbol “STL” and is subject to the rules of the NYSE for listed companies.
 
As a national bank, the bank is principally subject to the supervision, examination and reporting requirements of the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the “OCC”), as well as the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”). Insured banks, including the bank, are subject to extensive regulation of many aspects of their business. These regulations relate to, among other things: (a) the nature and amount of loans that may be made by the bank and the rates of interest that may be charged; (b) types and amounts of other investments; (c) branching; (d) permissible activities; (e) reserve requirements; and (f) dealings with officers, directors and affiliates.
 
 
PAGE 3

 
 
Sterling Banking Corporation is subject to supervision and regulation by the New York State Department of Financial Services (formerly the Banking Department of the State of New York).
 
Bank Holding Company Regulation
The BHCA requires the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board for the acquisition by a bank holding company of 5% or more of the voting stock or substantially all of the assets of any bank or bank holding company. Also, under the BHCA, bank holding companies are prohibited, with certain exceptions, from engaging in, or from acquiring 5% or more of the voting stock of any company engaging in, activities other than (1) banking or managing or controlling banks, (2) furnishing services to or performing services for their subsidiaries, or (3) activities that the Federal Reserve Board has determined to be so closely related to banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto.
 
As discussed below under “Financial Holding Company Regu­lation,” the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 amended the BHCA to permit a broader range of activities for bank holding companies that qualify as “financial holding companies.”
 
Under the Bank Merger Act, the prior approval of the OCC or other appropriate bank regulatory authority is required for a national bank to merge with another bank or purchase the assets or assume the deposits of another bank. In reviewing applications seeking approval of merger and acquisition transactions, the bank regulatory authorities will consider, among other things, the competitive effect and public benefits of the transactions, the capital position of the combined organization, the risks to the stability of the U.S. banking or financial system, the applicant’s performance record under the Commu­nity Reinvestment Act (the “CRA”) (see the section captioned “Community Reinvestment Act” included elsewhere in this item) and fair housing laws and the effectiveness of the subject organizations in combating money laundering activities.
 
Financial Holding Company Regulation
The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act:
• allows bank holding companies, subject to the requirements described below, to engage in a substantially broader range of nonbanking financial activities than was previously permissible, including (a) insurance underwriting and agency, (b) making merchant banking investments in commercial companies, (c) securities underwriting, dealing and market making, and (d) sponsoring mutual funds and investment companies;
• allows insurers and other financial services companies to acquire banks; and
• establishes the overall regulatory structure applicable to bank holding companies that also engage in insurance and securities operations.
 
Pursuant to an election made under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, the parent company has been designated as a financial holding company. As a financial holding company, Sterling may conduct, or acquire a company (other than a U.S. depository institution or foreign bank) engaged in, activities that are “financial in nature,” as well as additional activi­ties that the Federal Reserve Board determines (in the case of incidental activities, in conjunction with the United States Department of the Treasury (the “U.S. Treasury”)), are incidental or comple­men­tary to financial activities, without the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board. Under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, activities that are financial in nature include insurance, securities underwriting and dealing, merchant banking, and spon­soring mutual funds and investment companies. Under the merchant banking authority added by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, financial holding companies may invest in companies that engage in activities that are not otherwise permissible “financial” activities, subject to certain limitations, including that the financial holding company makes the investment with the intention of limiting the investment duration and does not manage the company on a day-to-day basis.
 
 
PAGE 4

 
 
To maintain financial holding company status, a financial holding company and all of its depository institution subsidiaries must be "well capitalized" and "well managed." A depository institution subsidiary is considered to be "well capitalized" if it satisfies the requirements for this status discussed in the sections captioned "Capital Adequacy" and "Prompt Corrective Action," included elsewhere in this item. A depository institution subsidiary is considered "well managed" if it received a composite rating and management rating of at least "satisfactory" in its most recent examination. A financial holding company's status will also depend upon it maintaining its status as "well capitalized" and "well managed" under applicable Federal Reserve Board regulations. If a financial holding company ceases to meet these capital and management requirements, the Federal Reserve Board's regulations provide that the financial holding company must enter into an agreement with the Federal Reserve Board to comply with all applicable capital and management requirements. Until the financial holding company returns to compliance, the Federal Reserve Board may impose limitations or conditions on the conduct of its activities, and the company may not commence any of the broader financial activities permissible for financial holding companies or acquire a company engaged in such financial activities without prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board. If the company does not return to compliance within 180 days, the Federal Reserve Board may require divestiture of the financial holding company's depository institutions.
 
In order for a financial holding company to commence any new activity permitted by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act or to acquire a company engaged in any new activity permitted by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, each insured depository institution subsidiary of the financial holding company must have received a rating of at least "satisfactory" in its most recent examination under the CRA. See the section captioned "Community Reinvestment Act" included elsewhere in this item.
 
Dodd-Frank Act
The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protec­tion Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which was enacted in July 2010, significantly restructures the financial regulatory regime in the United States. Although the Dodd-Frank Act’s provisions that have received the most public attention generally have been those applying to, or more likely to affect, larger institutions such as bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of $10 billion or more, it contains numerous other provisions that affect all bank holding companies and banks, including the Company and the bank, some of which are described in more detail below.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act amends the BHCA to require the federal financial regulatory agencies to adopt rules that prohibit banks and their affiliates from engaging in proprietary trading and investing in and sponsoring certain unregistered investment companies (defined as hedge funds and private equity funds). The statutory provision is commonly called the “Volcker Rule.” In October 2011, federal regulators proposed rules to implement the Volcker Rule that included an extensive request for comments on the proposal. Although the comment period has been closed for some time, a final rule has not been adopted. The proposed rules are highly complex and many aspects of the Volcker Rule remain unclear. We have analyzed how the proposed rules would affect us and, as proposed, do not anticipate that the Volcker Rule will have a material effect on the operations of the Company, as the Company does not engage in the businesses prohibited by the Volcker Rule. The Company may incur costs if it is required to adopt additional policies and systems to ensure compliance with the Volcker Rule, but any such costs are not expected to be material. However, the full impact on us will not be known with certainty until the rules are finalized and we have designed and implemented our compliance and related programs. Companies are expected to be required to be in compliance by July 2014 (subject to possible extension).
 
Some of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may have the consequence of increasing our expenses, decreasing our revenues, and changing the activities in which we choose to engage. The environment in which banking organizations will operate after the financial crisis, including legislative and regulatory changes affecting capital, liquidity, supervision, permissible activities, corporate governance and compensation, changes in fiscal policy and steps to eliminate government support for banking organizations, may have long-term effects on the business model and profitability of banking organizations that cannot now be foreseen. The specific impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on our current activities or new financial activities we may consider in the future, our financial performance and the markets in which we operate, will depend on the manner in which the relevant agencies develop and implement the required rules and the reaction of market participants to these regulatory developments. Many aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act are subject to rulemaking and will take effect over several years, making it difficult to anticipate the overall financial impact on the Company, its customers or the financial industry more generally. We will continue to assess our business, risk management, and compliance practices to conform to developments in the regulatory environment.
 
Payment of Dividends
The parent company depends for its cash requirements on funds maintained or generated by its subsidiaries, principally the bank.
 
Various legal restrictions limit the extent to which the bank can fund the parent company and its nonbank subsidiaries. All national banks are limited in the payment of dividends without the approval of the OCC to an amount not to exceed the net profits (as defined) for that year-to-date combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years, less any required transfers to surplus. Federal law also prohibits national banks from paying dividends that would be greater than the bank’s undivided profits after deducting statutory bad debt in excess of the bank’s allowance for loan losses. Under the foregoing restrictions, and while maintaining its “well capitalized” status, as of December 31, 2012, the bank could pay dividends of approximately $57.3 million to the parent company, without obtaining regulatory approval. This is not necessarily indicative of amounts that may be paid or are available to be paid in future periods.
 
Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improve­ment Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”), a depository institution, such as the bank, may not pay dividends if payment would cause it
 
 
PAGE 5

 
 
to become undercapitalized or if it is already undercapitalized. The payment of dividends by the parent company and the bank may also be affected or limited by other factors, such as the requirement to maintain adequate capital. The appropriate federal regulatory authority is authorized to determine under certain circumstances relating to the financial condition of a bank holding company or a bank that the payment of dividends would be an unsafe or unsound practice and to prohibit payment thereof. The appropriate federal regulatory authorities have indicated that paying dividends that deplete a bank’s capital base to an inadequate level would be an unsafe and unsound banking practice and that banking organizations should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings. In addition, in the current financial and economic environment, the Federal Reserve Board has indicated that bank holding companies should carefully review their dividend policy and has discouraged payment ratios that are at maximum allowable levels unless both asset quality and capital are very strong.
 
Transactions with Affiliates
Transactions between the parent company and its subsidiaries, on the one hand, and the bank and its other subsidiaries, on the other hand, are regulated by the Federal Reserve Board. These regulations limit the types and amounts of covered transactions engaged in by the bank and generally require those transactions to be on an arm’s-length basis. “Covered transactions” are defined by statute to include a loan or extension of credit, as well as a purchase of securities issued by an affiliate, a purchase of assets (unless otherwise exempted by the Federal Reserve Board) from the affiliate, certain derivative transactions that create a credit exposure to an affiliate, the acceptance of securities issued by the affiliate as collateral for a loan, and the issuance of a guarantee, acceptance or letter of credit on behalf of an affiliate. In general, these regulations require that any such transaction by the bank (or its subsidiaries) with an affiliate must be secured by designated amounts of specified collateral and must be limited to certain thresholds on an individual and aggregate basis.
 
Capital Adequacy
As a bank holding company, the parent company is subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. The bank is subject to similar capital requirements administered by the OCC. The federal regulatory authorities’ risk-based capital guidelines are based upon the 1988 capital accord (“Basel I”) of the Basel Committee. The Basel Committee is a committee of central banks and bank supervisors/regulators from the major industrialized countries that develops broad policy guidelines for use by each country’s supervisors in determining the supervisory policies they apply. The requirements are intended to ensure that banking organizations have adequate capital given the risk levels of assets and off-balance sheet financial instruments. Under the requirements, banking organizations are required to maintain minimum ratios for Tier 1 capital and total capital to risk-weighted assets (including certain off-balance sheet items, such as letters of credit). For purposes of calculating the ratios, a banking organization’s assets and some of its specified off-balance sheet commitments and obligations are assigned to various risk categories. A depository institution’s or holding company’s capital, in turn, is classified in tiers, depending on type:
• Core Capital (Tier 1). Currently, Tier 1 capital includes common equity, retained earnings, qualifying noncumulative perpetual preferred stock, minority interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, and, under existing standards, a limited amount of qualifying trust preferred securities, and qualifying cumulative perpetual preferred stock at the holding company level, less goodwill, most intangible assets and certain other assets.
• Supplementary Capital (Tier 2). Currently, Tier 2 capital includes, among other things, perpetual preferred stock not meeting the Tier 1 definition, qualifying mandatory convertible debt securities, qualifying subordinated debt, and allowances for loan and lease losses, subject to limitations.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act applies the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to bank holding companies such as the parent company, which, among other things as applied to the parent company, going forward will preclude the parent company from including in Tier 1 capital trust preferred securities or cumulative preferred stock issued on or after May 19, 2010. As of the date of this report the parent company did not have any trust preferred securities issued on or after that date or any cumulative preferred stock outstanding. The parent company's existing capital trust preferred securities are grandfathered as Tier 1 capital as its consolidated assets were less than $15 billion on December 31, 2009.
 
As a bank holding company, the parent company is currently required to maintain Tier 1 capital and “total capital” (the sum of Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) equal to at least 4.0% and 8.0%, respectively, of its total risk-weighted assets (including various off-balance-sheet items, such as standby letters of credit). National banks are required to maintain similar capital levels under capital adequacy guidelines. For a depository institution to be considered “well capitalized,” its Tier 1 and total capital ratios must be at least 6.0% and 10.0% on a risk-adjusted basis, respectively. The elements currently comprising Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital and the minimum Tier 1 capital and total capital ratios may in the future be subject to change, as discussed in greater detail below.
 
 
PAGE 6

 
 
Bank holding companies and banks are also required to comply with minimum leverage ratio requirements. The leverage ratio is the ratio of a banking organization’s Tier 1 capital to its total adjusted quarterly average assets (as defined for regulatory purposes). The requirements necessitate a minimum leverage ratio of 3.0% for financial holding companies and national banks that have the highest supervisory rating. All other bank holding companies and national banks are required to maintain a minimum leverage ratio of 4.0%, unless a different minimum is specified by an appropriate regulatory authority. For a depository institution to be considered “well capitalized,” its leverage ratio must be at least 5.0%. The bank regulatory agencies have encouraged banking organizations, including healthy, well-run banking organizations, to operate with capital ratios substantially in excess of the stated ratios required to maintain “well capitalized” status. This has resulted from, among other things, current economic conditions, the global financial crisis and the likelihood, as described below, of increased formal capital requirements for banking organizations. In light of the foregoing, the Company and the bank expect that they will maintain capital ratios substantially in excess of these ratios.
 
In 2012, the Company’s primary federal regulators, the Federal Reserve Board and the OCC, published two notices of proposed rulemaking (the “2012 Capital Proposals”) that would substantially revise the risk-based capital requirements applicable to bank holding companies and depository institutions, including the parent company and the bank, compared to the current U.S. risk-based capital rules, which are based on the aforementioned Basel I capital accords of the Basel Committee. One of the 2012 Capital Proposals (the “Basel III Proposal”) addresses the components of capital and other issues affecting the numerator in banking institutions’ regulatory capital ratios and would implement the Basel Committee’s December 2010 framework known as “Basel III” for strengthening international capital standards. The other proposal (the “Standardized Approach Proposal”) addresses risk weights and other issues affecting the denominator in banking institutions’ regulatory capital ratios and would replace the existing Basel I-derived risk-weighting approach with a more risk-sensitive approach based, in part, on the standardized approach in the Basel Committee’s 2004 “Basel II” capital accords. The 2012 Capital Proposals would also implement the requirements of Section 939A of the Dodd-Frank Act to remove references to credit ratings from the federal banking agencies’ rules. As proposed, the Basel III Proposal and the Standardized Approach Proposal would come into effect on January 1, 2013 (subject to a phase-in period) and January 1, 2015 (with an option for early adoption), respectively; however, final rules have not yet been adopted, and the Basel III framework is therefore not yet applicable to the parent company and the bank.
 
The Basel III Proposal, among other things, (i) introduces as a new capital measure “Common Equity Tier 1” (“CET1”), (ii) specifies that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting specified requirements, (iii) defines CET1 narrowly by requiring that most adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital and (iv) expands the scope of the adjustments as compared to existing regulations.
 
When fully phased-in on January 1, 2019, the Basel III Proposal would require banks to maintain (i) as a newly adopted international stand­ard, a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 4.5%, plus a 2.5% “capital conservation buffer” (which is added to the 4.5% CET1 ratio as that buffer is phased-in, effectively resulting in a minimum ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets of at least 7% upon full implementation), (ii) a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of at least 6.0%, plus the capital conservation buffer (which is added to the 6.0% Tier 1 capital ratio as that buffer is phased-in, effectively resulting in a minimum Tier 1 capital ratio of 8.5% upon full implementation), (iii) a minimum ratio of total capital (that is, Tier 1 plus Tier 2) to risk-weighted assets of at least 8.0%, plus the capital conservation buffer (which is added to the 8.0% total capital ratio as that buffer is phased-in, effectively resulting in a minimum total capital ratio of 10.5% upon full implementation) and (iv) as a newly adopted international standard, a minimum leverage ratio of 3%, calculated as the ratio of Tier 1 capital to balance sheet exposures plus certain off-balance sheet exposures (as the average for each quarter of the month-end ratios for the quarter).
 
The Basel III Proposal also provides for a “countercyclical capital buffer” that is applicable to only certain covered institutions and is not expected to have any current applicability to the parent company or the bank.
 
The aforementioned capital conservation buffer is designed to absorb losses during periods of economic stress. Banking institutions with a ratio of CET1 to risk-weighted assets above the minimum but below the conservation buffer (or below the combined capital conservation buffer and countercyclical capital buffer, when the latter is applied) will face constraints on dividends, equity repurchases and compensation based on the amount of the shortfall.
 
 
PAGE 7

 
 
Under the Basel III Proposal, the initial minimum capital ratios would be the following:
• 3.5% CET1 to risk-weighted assets.
• 4.5% Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets.
• 8.0% Total capital to risk-weighted assets.
 
The Basel III Proposal provides for a number of deductions from and adjustments to CET1. These include, for example, the requirement that mortgage servicing rights, deferred tax assets dependent upon future taxable income and significant investments in nonconsolidated financial entities be deducted from CET1 to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10% of CET1 or all such categories in the aggregate exceed 15% of CET1. Under current capital standards, the effects of accumulated other comprehensive income items included in capital are excluded for the purposes of determining regulatory capital ratios. Under the Basel III Proposal, the effects of accumulated other comprehensive items are not excluded, which could result in significant variations in level of capital depending upon the impact of interest rate fluctuations on the fair value of the Company’s investment securities portfolio.
 
Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 will begin on January 1, 2014 and will be phased-in over a five-year period (20% per year). The implementation of the capital conservation buffer will begin on January 1, 2016 at the 0.625% level and be phased-in over a four-year period (increasing by that amount on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5% on January 1, 2019).
 
With respect to the bank, the Basel III Proposal would also revise the “prompt corrective action” regulations pursuant to Section 38 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, by (i) introducing a CET1 ratio requirement at each level (other than critically undercapitalized), with the required CET1 ratio being 6.5% for well-capitalized status; (ii) increasing the minimum Tier 1 capital ratio requirement for each category, with the minimum Tier 1 capital ratio for well-capitalized status being 8% (as compared to the current 6%); and (iii) eliminating the current provision that provides that a bank with a composite supervisory rating of 1 may have a 3% leverage ratio and still be well-capitalized.
 
The federal banking agencies in 2008 proposed, as an option for banking institutions that are not subject to the advanced risk-weighting approaches of Basel II, an approach based upon the Basel II standardized risk-weighting approach, but the agencies never proceeded with it. The Standardized Approach Proposal expands upon the initial U.S. Basel II approach from 2008 but would be mandatory and, because of the Dodd-Frank Act’s prohibition on the use of credit ratings, would substitute non ratings-based alternatives for Basel II’s heavy reliance on credit ratings.
 
The Standardized Approach Proposal would expand the risk-weighting categories from the current four Basel I-derived categories (0%, 20%, 50% and 100%) to a much larger and more risk-sensitive number of categories, depending on the nature of the assets, generally ranging from 0% for U.S. government and agency securities, to 600% for certain equity exposures, and resulting in higher risk weights for a variety of asset categories, including many residential mortgages and certain commercial real estate. Specifics include, among other things:
• Applying a 150% risk weight instead of a 100% risk weight for certain high volatility commercial real estate acquisition, development and construction loans.
• For residential mortgage exposures, the current approach of a 50% risk weight for high-quality seasoned mortgages and a 100% risk-weight for all other mortgages is replaced with a risk weight of between 35% and 200% depending upon the mortgage’s loan-to-value ratio and whether the mortgage is a “category 1” or “category 2” residential mortgage exposure (based on eight criteria that include the term, use of negative amortization, balloon payments and certain rate increases).
• Assigning a 150% risk weight to exposures (other than residential mortgage exposures) that are 90 days past due.
• Providing for a 20% credit conversion factor for the unused portion of a commitment with an original maturity of one year or less that is not unconditionally cancellable (currently set at 0%).
• Providing for a risk weight, generally not less than 20% with certain exceptions, for securities lending transactions based on the risk weight category of the underlying collateral securing the transaction.
• Providing for a 100% risk weight for claims on securities firms.
• Eliminating the current 50% cap on the risk weight for OTC derivatives.
 
In addition, the Standardized Approach Proposal also provides more advantageous risk weights for derivatives and repurchase-style transactions cleared through a qualifying central counterparty and increases the scope of eligible guarantors and eligible collateral for purposes of credit risk mitigation.
 
 
PAGE 8

 
 
Management believes that, as of December 31, 2012, the parent company and the bank would meet all capital adequacy requirements under the Basel III and Standardized Approach Proposals on a fully phased-in basis if such requirements were currently effective. There can be no guarantee that the Basel III and the Standardized Approach Proposals will be adopted in their current form, what changes may be made before adoption, or when ultimate adoption will occur. Requirements to maintain higher levels of capital or to maintain higher levels of liquid assets could adversely impact the Company’s net income and return on equity.
 
Liquidity Requirements
Historically, regulation and monitoring of bank and bank holding company liquidity has been addressed as a supervisory matter, without required formulaic measures. The Basel III liquidity framework requires banks and bank holding companies to measure their liquidity against specific liquidity tests that, although similar in some respects to liquidity measures historically applied by banks and regulators for management and supervisory purposes, going forward would be required by regulation. One test, referred to as the liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”), is designed to ensure that the banking entity maintains an adequate level of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets equal to the entity’s expected net cash outflow for a 30-day time horizon (or, if greater, 25% of its expected total cash outflow) under an acute liquidity stress scenario. The other test, referred to as the net stable funding ratio (“NSFR”), is designed to promote more medium- and long-term funding of the assets and activities of banking entities over a one-year time horizon. These requirements will incent banking entities to increase their holdings of U.S. Treasury securities and other sovereign debt as a component of assets and increase the use of long-term debt as a funding source. The Basel III liquidity framework contemplates that the LCR will be subject to an observation period continuing through mid-2013 and, subject to any revisions resulting from the analyses conducted and data collected during the observation period, implemented as a minimum LCR of 60% on January 1, 2015 with a phase-in continuing through 2019. Similarly, it contemplates that the NSFR will be subject to an observation period through mid-2016 and, subject to any revisions resulting from the analyses conducted and data collected during the observation period, implemented as a minimum standard by January 1, 2018. These new standards are subject to further rulemaking and their terms may well change before implementation. The federal banking agencies have not proposed rules implementing the Basel III liquidity framework and have not determined to what extent they will apply to U.S. banks that are not large, internationally active banks.
 
Prompt Corrective Action
The Federal Deposit Insurance Act, as amended (“FDIA”), requires, among other things, the federal banking agencies to take “prompt corrective action” in respect of depository institutions that do not meet minimum capital requirements. The FDIA includes the following five capital tiers: “well capitalized,” “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized.” A depository institution’s capital tier will depend upon how its capital levels compare with various relevant capital measures and certain other factors, as established by regulation. The relevant capital measures are the total capital ratio, the Tier 1 capital ratio and the leverage ratio.
 
A bank will be: (i) “well capitalized” if the insti­tution has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater, and a leverage ratio of 5.0% or greater, and is not subject to any order or written directive by any such regulatory authority to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure; (ii) “adequately capitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.0% or greater, and a leverage ratio of 4.0% or greater and is not “well capitalized”; (iii) “undercapitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based ratio that is less than 8.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 4.0% or a leverage ratio of less than 4.0%; (iv) “significantly undercapitalized” if the institution has a total risk-based capital ratio of less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of less than 3.0% or a leverage ratio of less than 3.0%; and (v) “critically undercapitalized” if the institution’s tangible equity is equal to or less than 2.0% of average quarterly tangible assets. An institution may be downgraded to, or deemed to be in, a capital category that is lower than that indicated by its capital ratios if it is determined to be in an unsafe or unsound condition or if it receives an unsatisfactory examination rating with respect to certain matters. As of December 31, 2012, the Company and the bank were “well capitalized,” based on the ratios and guidelines described above. A bank’s capital category is determined solely for the purpose of applying prompt cor­rective action regulations, and the capital category may not constitute an accurate representation of the bank’s over­all financial condition or prospects for other purposes.
 
The FDIA generally prohibits a depository institution from making any capital distributions (including payment of a dividend) or paying any management fee to its parent holding company if the depository institution would thereafter be undercapitalized. Undercapitalized institutions are subject to growth limitations and are required to submit a capital restoration plan. The agencies may not accept such a plan without
 
 
PAGE 9

 
 
determining, among other things, that the plan is based on realistic assumptions and is likely to succeed in restoring the depository institution’s capital. In addition, for a capital restoration plan to be acceptable, the depository institution’s parent holding company must guarantee that the institution will comply with such a capital restoration plan. The aggregate liability of the parent holding company is limited to the lesser of (i) an amount equal to 5.0% of the depository institution’s total assets at the time it became undercapitalized and (ii) the amount which is necessary (or would have been necessary) to bring the institution into compliance with all capital standards applicable with respect to such institution as of the time it fails to comply with the plan. If a depository institution fails to submit an acceptable plan, it is treated as if it is “significantly undercapitalized.”
 
“Significantly undercapitalized” depository institutions may be subject to a number of requirements and restrictions, including orders to sell sufficient voting stock to become “adequately capitalized,” requirements to reduce total assets, and cessation of receipt of deposits from correspondent banks. “Critically undercapitalized” institutions are subject to the appointment of a receiver or conservator.
 
Support of the Bank
Federal Reserve Board policy historically required a bank holding company to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks. The Dodd-Frank Act codified this policy as a statutory requirement. As a result, the Federal Reserve Board may require the parent company to stand ready to use its resources to provide adequate capital funds to its banking subsidiaries during periods of financial stress or adversity. This support may be required at times by the Federal Reserve Board even though the parent company may not be in a financial position to provide such support. In addition, any capital loans by a bank holding company to any of its subsidiary banks are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of such subsidiary banks. The BHCA provides that, in the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the bank holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to priority of payment. Further­more, under the National Bank Act, if the capital stock of the bank is impaired by losses or otherwise, the OCC is authorized to require payment of the deficiency by assessment upon the parent company. If the assessment is not paid within three months, the OCC could order a sale of the capital stock of the bank held by the parent company to make good the deficiency.
 
FDIC Insurance
The FDIC utilizes a risk-based assessment system that imposes insurance premiums based upon a risk matrix that, as described below, takes into account, among other things, a bank’s capital level and supervisory rating (its “CAMELS rating”).
 
Substantially all of the deposits of the bank are insured up to applicable limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”) of the FDIC and are subject to deposit insurance assessments to maintain the DIF. Deposit insurance assessments are based on average total assets minus average tangible equity.
 
The initial base assessment rate ranges from 5 to 35 basis points on an annualized basis. After the effect of potential base-rate adjustments, the total base assessment rate could range from 2.5 to 45 basis points on an annualized basis. As the DIF reserve ratio grows, the rate schedule will be adjusted downward. Additionally, an institution must pay an additional premium equal to 50 basis points on every dollar (above 3% of an institution’s Tier 1 capital) of long-term, unsecured debt held that was issued by another insured depository institution (excluding debt guaranteed under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program). Any increase in insurance assessments could have an adverse impact on the earnings of insured institutions, including the bank. The bank paid a deposit insurance premium in 2012 amounting to $1.6 million.
 
In addition, the bank is required to make payments for the servicing of obligations of the Financing Corporation (“FICO”) issued in connection with the resolution of savings and loan associations, so long as such obligations remain outstanding. The bank paid a FICO assessment in 2012 amounting to $150 thousand. The FICO annualized assessment rate for the first quarter of 2013 is 0.64 cents per $100 of deposits.
 
On November 17, 2009, the FDIC implemented a final rule requiring insured institutions to prepay their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009, and for all of 2010, 2011 and 2012. Such prepaid assessments were collected by the FDIC on December 30, 2009, along with each institution’s quarterly risk-based deposit insurance assessment for the third quarter of 2009. As of December 31, 2012, $1.2 million in pre-paid deposit insurance is included in “Other assets” in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.
 
In October 2010, the FDIC adopted a new DIF restoration plan to ensure that the fund reserve ratio reaches 1.35% by September 30, 2020, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act. At
 
 
PAGE 10

 
 
least semi-annually, the FDIC will update its loss and income projections for the fund and, if needed, will increase or decrease assessment rates, following notice-and-comment rulemaking if required.
 
In November 2010, the FDIC issued a final rule to implement provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that provide for temporary unlimited coverage for noninterest-bearing transaction accounts. The separate coverage for noninterest-bearing transaction accounts became effective on December 31, 2010 and terminated on December 31, 2012.
 
Under the FDIA, insurance of deposits may be terminated by the FDIC upon a finding that the institution has engaged in unsafe and unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC.
 
In its resolution of the problems of an insured depository institution in default or in danger of default, the FDIC is generally required to satisfy its obligations to insured depositors at the least possible cost to the DIF. In addition, the FDIC may not take any action that would have the effect of increasing the losses to the deposit insurance fund by protecting depositors for more than the insured portion of deposits or creditors other than depositors.
 
Incentive Compensation
The Dodd-Frank Act requires U.S. financial regulators, including the Federal Reserve Board, to establish joint regulations or guidelines prohibiting incentive-based payment arrangements at certain regulated entities, including bank holding companies and national banks, having at least $1 billion in total assets, that encourage inappropriate risks by providing an executive officer, employee, director or principal shareholder with excessive compensation, fees or benefits or that could lead to material financial loss to the entity. In addition, these regulators must establish regulations or guidelines requiring enhanced disclosure to regulators of incentive-based compensation arrangements. The initial version of these regulations was proposed by the U.S. financial regulators in February 2011 but the regulations have not been finalized. If the regulations are adopted in the form initially proposed, they will impose limitations on the manner in which we may structure compensation, and require us to adopt additional policies and procedures.
 
In June 2010, the Federal Reserve, OCC and FDIC issued comprehensive final guidance on incentive compensation policies intended to ensure that the incentive compensation policies of banking organizations do not undermine the safety and soundness of such organizations by encouraging excessive risk-taking. The incentive compensation guidelines, which cover all employees that have the ability to materially affect the risk profile of an organization, either individually or as part of a group, are based upon the key principles that a banking organization’s incentive compensation arrangements should (i) provide incentives that do not encourage risk-taking beyond the organization’s ability to effectively identify and manage risks, (ii) be compatible with effective internal controls and risk management, and (iii) be supported by strong corporate governance, including active and effective oversight by the organization’s board of directors. These three principles are incorporated into the proposed joint compensation regulations under the Dodd-Frank Act discussed above.
 
The Federal Reserve will review, as part of the regular, risk-focused examination process, the incentive compensation arrangements of banking organizations, such as the Company, that are not “large, complex banking organizations.” These reviews will be tailored to each organization based on the scope and complexity of the organization’s activities and the prevalence of incentive compensation arrangements. The findings of the supervisory initiatives will be included in reports of examination. Deficiencies will be incorporated into the organization’s supervisory ratings, which can affect the organization’s ability to make acquisitions and take other actions. Enforcement actions may be taken against a banking organization if its incentive compensation arrangements, or related risk-management control or governance processes, pose a risk to the organization’s safety and soundness and the organization is not taking prompt and effective measures to correct the deficiencies.
 
In addition, in the first half of 2011, the SEC adopted rules concerning say-on-pay votes and golden parachute compensation arrangements. These rules require us to make enhanced disclosures to the SEC, and require us to provide our shareholders with a nonbinding say-on-pay vote to approve the compensation of the named executive officers, a nonbinding vote to determine how often the say-on-pay vote will occur and, in certain circumstances, a nonbinding vote to approve, and proxy disclosure of, golden parachute compensation arrangements.
 
The scope and content of the U.S. banking regulators’ policies on executive compensation are continuing to develop and are likely to continue evolving in the near future. It cannot be determined at this time whether compliance with such policies will adversely affect the ability of Sterling and its subsidiaries to hire, retain and motivate its and their key employees.
 
Depositor Preference
The FDIA provides that, in the event of the “liquidation or other resolution” of an insured depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution, including the claims of the FDIC
 
 
PAGE 11

 

as subrogee of insured depositors, and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver, will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution. If an insured depository institution fails, insured and uninsured depositors, along with the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured, non-deposit creditors, including the parent bank holding company, with respect to any extensions of credit they have made to such insured depository institution.
 
Community Reinvestment Act
The CRA requires depository institutions to assist in meeting the credit needs of their market areas consistent with safe and sound banking practice. Under the CRA, each depository institution is required to help meet the credit needs of its market areas by, among other things, providing credit to low- and moderate-income individuals and communities. Depository institutions are periodically examined for compliance with the CRA and are assigned ratings. In order for a financial holding company to commence any new activity permitted by the BHCA, or to acquire any company engaged in any new activity permitted by the BHCA, each insured depository institution subsidiary of the financial holding company must have received a rating of at least “satisfactory” in its most recent examination under the CRA. Furthermore, banking regulators take into account CRA ratings when considering approval of a proposed transaction. In its most recent CRA exam report the bank received a rating of “satisfactory.”
 
Financial Privacy
In accordance with the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act, federal banking regulators adopted rules that limit the ability of banks and other financial institutions to disclose nonpublic information about consumers to nonaffiliated third parties. These limitations require disclosure of privacy policies to consumers and, in some circumstances, allow consumers to prevent disclosure of certain personal information to a nonaffiliated third party. The privacy provisions of the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act affect how consumer information is transmitted through diversified financial companies and conveyed to outside vendors.
 
Anti-Money Laundering Initiatives and the USA Patriot Act
A major focus of governmental policy on financial institutions in recent years has been aimed at combating money laundering and terrorist financing. The USA Patriot Act of 2001 (the “USA Patriot Act”) substantially broadened the scope of United States anti-money laundering laws and regulations by imposing significant new compliance and due diligence obligations, creating new crimes and penalties and expanding the extra-territorial jurisdiction of the United States. The U.S. Treasury has issued a number of implementing regulations, which apply to various requirements of the USA Patriot Act to financial institutions such as the Company. These regulations impose obligations on financial institutions to maintain appropriate policies, procedures and controls to detect, prevent and report money laundering and terrorist financing and to verify the identity of their customers. Failure of a financial institution to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing, or to comply with all of the relevant laws or regulations, could have serious legal and reputational consequences for the institution, including the imposition of enforcement actions and civil monetary penalties.
 
Office of Foreign Assets Control Regulation
The United States has imposed economic sanctions that affect transactions with designated foreign countries, nationals and others. These sanctions, which are administered by the U.S. Treasury Department Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”), take many different forms. Generally, however, they contain one or more of the following elements: (i) restrictions on trade with or investment in a sanctioned country, including prohibitions against direct or indirect imports from and exports to a sanctioned country and prohibitions on “U.S. persons” engaging in financial transactions relating to making investments in, or providing investment-related advice or assistance to, a sanctioned country; and (ii) a blocking of assets in which the government or specially designated nation­als of the sanctioned country have an interest, by prohibiting transfers of property subject to U.S. jurisdiction (including property in the possession or control of U.S. persons). Blocked assets (for example, property and bank deposits) cannot be paid out, withdrawn, set off or transferred in any manner without a license from OFAC. Failure to comply with these sanctions could have serious legal, financial and reputational consequences.
 
Legislative Initiatives and Regulatory Reform
From time to time, various legislative and regulatory initiatives are introduced in Congress and state legislatures, as well as by regulatory agencies. Such initiatives may include proposals to expand or contract the powers of bank holding companies and depository institutions or proposals to substantially change the financial institution regulatory system. Such legislation could change banking statutes and the operating environment of the Company in substantial and unpredictable ways. If
 
 
PAGE 12

 

enacted, such legislation could increase or decrease the cost of doing business, limit or expand permissible activities or affect the competitive balance among banks, savings associations, credit unions and other financial institutions. The Company cannot predict whether any such legislation will be enacted, and, if enacted, the effect that it, or any implementing regulations, would have on the financial condition or results of operations of the Company. A change in statutes, regulations or regulatory policies applicable to the Company could have a material effect on the business of the Company.
 
As a result of the continued volatility and instability in the financial system, the Congress, the bank regulatory authorities and other government agencies have called for or proposed additional regulation and restrictions on the activities, practices and operations of banks and their holding companies. The Congress and the federal banking agencies have broad authority to require all banks and holding companies to adhere to more rigorous or costly operating procedures, corporate governance procedures, or to engage in activities or practices, which they would not otherwise elect.
 
We cannot predict whether or in what form further legislation and/or regulations may be adopted or the extent to which Sterling’s business may be affected thereby.
 
Safety and Soundness Standards
Federal banking agencies promulgate safety and soundness standards relating to, among other things, internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation, fees, and benefits. With respect to internal controls, information systems and internal audit systems, the stand­ards describe the functions that adequate internal controls and information systems must be able to perform, including: (i) monitoring adherence to prescribed policies; (ii) effective risk management; (iii) timely and accurate financial, operations, and regulatory reporting; (iv) safeguarding and managing assets; and (v) compliance with applicable laws and regulations. The standards also include requirements that: (i) those performing internal audits be qualified and independent; (ii) internal controls and information systems be tested and reviewed; (iii) corrective actions be adequately documented; and (iv) results of an audit be made available for review of management actions. In addition, federal banking agencies adopted regulations that authorize, but do not require, an agency to order an institution that has been given notice by an agency that it is not satisfying any of such safety and soundness standards to submit a compliance plan. If, after being so notified, an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan or fails in any material respect to implement an acceptable compliance plan, the agency must issue an order directing action to correct the deficiency and may issue an order directing other actions of the types to which an undercapitalized institution is subject under the “prompt corrective action” provisions of the FDIA. See “Prompt Corrective Action” above. If an institution fails to comply with such an order, the agency may seek to enforce such order in judicial proceedings and to impose civil money penalties.
 
Consequences of Noncompliance with Supervision or Regulation
Federal banking law grants substantial enforcement powers to federal banking regulators. This enforcement authority includes, among other things, the ability to assess criminal and civil monetary penalties, to issue cease-and-desist or removal orders to terminate FDIC insurance, to revoke our banking charter and to initiate injunctive actions against banking organizations and institution-affiliated parties. In general, these enforcement actions may be initiated for violations of laws, regulations, policies and supervisory guidance and for unsafe or unsound practices. Other actions or inactions may provide the basis for enforcement action, including misleading or untimely reports filed with regulatory authorities.
 
The bank and its “institution-affiliated parties,” including its directors, management, employees, agents, independent contractors, consultants such as attorneys and accountants and others who participate in the conduct of the financial institution’s affairs, are subject to potential civil and criminal penalties for violations of law, regulations or written orders of a government agency. In addition, regulators are provided with greater flexibility to commence enforcement actions against institutions and institution-affiliated parties. Possible enforcement actions include the termination of deposit insurance and cease-and-desist orders. Such orders may, among other things, require affirmative action to correct any harm resulting from a violation or practice, including restitution, reimbursement, indemnifications or guarantees against loss. A financial institution may also be ordered to restrict its growth, dispose of certain assets, rescind agreements or contracts, or take other actions as determined by the ordering agency to be appropriate.
 
Under provisions of the federal securities laws, a determination by a court or regulatory agency that certain violations have occurred at a company or its affiliates can result in fines, restitution, a limitation of permitted activities, disqualification to continue to conduct certain activities and an inability to rely on certain favorable exemptions. Certain types of infractions and violations can also affect a public company in its timing and ability to expeditiously issue new securities into the capital markets.
 
 
PAGE 13

 

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED STATISTICAL INFORMATION
 
I. Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity; Interest Rates and Interest Differential
The information appears on pages 47 and 48 in “MAN­AGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINAN­CIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
II. Investment Portfolio
A summary of the Company’s investment securities by type with related carrying values at the end of each of the three most recent fiscal years appears beginning on page 38 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” Information regarding book values and range of maturities by type of security and weighted average yields for totals of each category appears on pages 39 and 40 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
III. Loan Portfolio
A table setting forth the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio, net of unearned discounts, at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years appears beginning on page 41 in “MAN­AGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
A table setting forth the maturities and sensitivity to changes in interest rates of the Company’s commercial and industrial loans at December 31, 2012 appears on page 41 in “MANAGE­MENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
It is the policy of the Company to consider all customer requests for extensions of original maturity dates (rollovers), whether in whole or in part, as though each was an application for a new loan subject to standard approval criteria, including credit evaluation. Additional information appears under “Loan Portfolio” beginning on page 40 in “MANAGE­MENT’S DISCUS­SION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS” and under “Loans” in Note 1 and in Note 5 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
A table setting forth the aggregate amount of domestic nonaccrual, past due and restructured loans of the Company at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years appears on page 42 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS”; there were no foreign loans accounted for on a nonaccrual basis. Information regarding loans that have undergone a troubled debt restructuring and impaired loans is presented under “Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses” in Note 5 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Loan concentration information is presented in Note 5 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Information regarding Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock is presented in Note 1 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
IV. Summary of Loan Loss Experience
A summary of loan loss experience appears in Note 5 of the Company’s con­solidated financial statements and beginning on page 41 under “Asset Quality” in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CON­DITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” A table setting forth certain information with respect to the Company’s loan loss experience for each of the five most recent fiscal years appears on page 44 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUS­SION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
The Company considers its allowance for loan losses to be adequate based upon the size and risk characteristics of the outstanding loan portfolio at December 31, 2012. Net losses within the loan portfolio are not, however, statistically predictable and are subject to various external factors that are beyond the control of the Company. Consequently, changes in conditions in the next twelve months could result in future provisions for loan losses varying from the provision recorded in 2012.
 
A table presenting the Company’s allocation of the allowance  at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years appears on page 45 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” This allocation is based on estimates by management that may vary based on management’s evaluation of the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio. The amount allocated to a particular loan category may not necessarily be indicative of actual future charge-offs in that loan category.
 
V. Deposits
Average deposits and average rates paid for each of the three most recent years are presented on page 47 in “MAN­AGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CON­DITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
Outstanding time certificates of deposit issued from domestic and foreign offices and interest expense on domestic and foreign deposits are presented in Note 7 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
 
PAGE 14

 
 
The table providing selected information with respect to the Company’s deposits for each of the three most recent fiscal years appears on page 46 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUS­SION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
Interest expense for the three most recent fiscal years is presented in Note 7 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
VI. Return on Assets and Equity
The Company’s returns on average total assets and average shareholders’ equity, dividend payout ratio and average shareholders’ equity to average total assets for each of the five most recent years is presented in “SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA” on page 29.
 
VII. Short-Term Borrowings
Balance and rate data for significant categories of the Company’s short-term borrowings for each of the three most recent years is presented in Note 8 and in Note 9 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
INFORMATION AVAILABLE ON OUR WEB SITE
 
The Company’s Internet address is www.sterlingbancorp.com and the investor relations section of our web site is located at www.sterlingbancorp.com/ir/investor.cfm. The Company makes available free of charge, on or through the investor relations section of the Company’s web site, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company electronically files such material with, or furnishes it to, the SEC.
 
Also posted on the Company’s web site, and available in print upon request of any shareholder to our Investor Relations Department, are the Charters for our Board of Directors’ Audit Committee, Compensation Committee and Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee, our Corporate Governance Guidelines, our Method for Interested Persons to Communicate with Non-Management Directors, our policy on excessive or luxury expenditures and a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics governing our directors, officers and employees. Within the time period required by the SEC and the NYSE, the Company will post on our web site any amendment to the Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and any waiver applicable to our senior financial officers, as defined in the Code, or our executive officers or directors. In addition, information concerning purchases and sales of our equity securities by our executive officers and directors is posted on our web site. The contents of the Company’s web site are not incorporated by reference into this annual report on Form 10-K.
 
ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS
 
An investment in the parent company’s common shares is subject to risks inherent to the Company’s business. The most significant risks and uncertainties that management believes affect the Company are described below. Before making an investment decision, you should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below together with all of the other information included or incorporated by reference in this report. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones facing the Company. Additional risks and uncertainties that management is not aware of or focused on, or that management currently deems less significant, may also impair the Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations. This report is qualified in its entirety by these risk factors.
 
If any of the following risks adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition or results of operations, the value of the parent company’s common shares could decline significantly and you could lose all or part of your investment.
 
RISKS RELATED TO THE COMPANY’S BUSINESS
 
The Company’s Business May Be Adversely Affected by Conditions in the Financial Markets and Economic Conditions Generally
From December 2007 through June 2009, the United States experienced a recession and a slowing of economic activity. Business activity across a wide range of industries and regions was greatly reduced. The real estate sector, and the related segments of the construction business sector, were particularly severely affected. Local governments and many businesses were in serious difficulty, due to the lack of consumer spending and the lack of liquidity in the credit markets. Unemployment had increased significantly.
 
Since then, the financial services industry and the securities markets generally have been materially and adversely affected at times by significant declines in the values of asset classes and by a lack of liquidity. This was initially triggered by declines in home prices and the values of subprime mortgages, but spread to all mortgage and real estate asset classes, to leveraged bank loans and to nearly all asset classes, including equities.
 
Although U.S. economic conditions have generally improved from 2008 and 2009 levels, certain sectors, such as real estate and manufacturing, remain weak and unemployment remains high. Despite the actions of the U.S. Government
 
 
PAGE 15

 
 
and the Federal Reserve Board, both with respect to monetary policy, fiscal policy and increased regulations meant to restore investor confidence, the overall business environment in 2012 was adverse for many households and businesses in the United States and worldwide. In addition, concerns over U.S. fiscal policy, budget deficit issues and political debate over the debt ceiling have created additional economic and market uncertainty.
 
Internationally, the weakness of certain foreign banks and the increasing danger of sovereign defaults has led to continuing high levels of uncertainty and volatility in the international financial markets. In particular, concerns about the European Union’s sovereign debt crisis have also caused uncertainty for financial markets globally. Such risks could indirectly affect the Company by affecting its hedging or other counterparties, as well as the Company’s customers with European businesses or assets denominated in the euro or companies in the Company’s market with European businesses or affiliates.
 
The Company’s financial performance generally, and in particular the ability of borrowers to pay interest on and repay the principal of outstanding loans and the value of collateral securing those loans, is highly dependent upon the business environment in the markets where the Company operates, in the New York metropolitan area and in the United States as a whole. A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, economic growth, efficient capital markets, low inflation, high business and investor confidence and strong business earnings. Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by: declines in economic growth, business activity or investor or business confidence; limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital; increases in inflation or interest rates; state and national fiscal disruptions; natural disasters; or a combination of these or other factors. The business environment in the New York metropolitan area, the United States and worldwide has generally improved since the recession, but there can be no assurance that these conditions will continue to improve in the near term. A slowing of improvement or a return to deteriorating economic conditions could adversely affect the credit quality of the Company’s loans, business results of operations and financial condition.
 
Market Volatility May Adversely Impact Our Business, Financial Condition and Results of Operations and Our Ability to Manage Risk
The capital and credit markets experienced unprecedented volatility and disruption during the 2008 financial crisis. During times of market stress, our hedging and other risk management strategies may not be as effective at mitigating securities trading losses as they would be under less volatile market conditions. Further market volatility could produce downward pressure on our stock price and credit availability without regard to our underlying financial strength. The broad decline in stock prices throughout the financial services industry, which has also affected our common shares, could require a goodwill impairment test. A substantial goodwill impairment charge could have an adverse impact on our results of operations. Severe market events have historically been difficult to predict, however, and we could realize significant losses if extreme market events were to occur. For a discussion of risk, see “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT” beginning on page 49 in “MANAGE­MENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.” If markets experience further upheavals, there can be no assurance that we will not experience an adverse effect, which may be material, on our ability to manage risk and on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
We May Experience Write-downs of Investment Securities that We Own and Other Losses Related to Volatile and Illiquid Market Conditions, Reducing Our Earnings
We maintain an investment securities portfolio of various holdings, types and maturities. These securities are generally classified as available for sale and, consequently, are recorded on our balance sheet at fair value with unrealized gains or losses reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax. Our portfolio includes residential mortgage-backed securities, agency notes, municipal obligations and corporate debt securities, the values of which are subject to market price volatility to the extent unhedged. This volatility affects the amount of our capital. In addition, if such investments suffer credit losses, we may recognize the credit losses as an other-than-temporary impairment which could impact our revenue in the quarter in which we recognize the losses. If we experience losses related to our investment securities portfolio in the future, it could ultimately adversely affect our results of operations and capital levels. For information regarding our investment securities portfolio, see “BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS—Securities” beginning on page 37 and for information regarding the sensitivity of and risks asso­ciated with the market value of portfolio investments and interest rates, refer to “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT—Market Risk” beginning on page 49, both of which are in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
 
PAGE 16

 
 
Improvements in Economic Indicators Disproportionately Affecting the Financial Services Industry May Lag Improvements in the General Economy
The improvement of certain economic indicators, such as unemployment and real estate asset values and rents, may nevertheless continue to lag behind the overall economy. These economic indicators typically affect certain industries, such as real estate and financial services, more significantly. For example, improvements in commercial real estate fundamentals typically lag broad economic recovery by 12 to 18 months. The Company’s clients include entities active in these industries. Furthermore, financial services companies with a substantial lending business are dependent upon the ability of their borrowers to make debt service payments on loans. Should unemployment or real estate asset values fail to recover for an extended period of time, the Company could be adversely affected.
 
The Company Is Subject to Interest Rate Risk
The Company’s earnings and cash flows are largely dependent upon its net interest income. Net interest income is the difference between interest income earned on interest-earning assets such as loans and securities and interest expense paid on interest-bearing liabilities such as deposits and borrowed funds. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond the Company’s control, including general economic conditions and policies of various governmental and regulatory agencies and, in particular, the Federal Open Market Committee. Changes in monetary policy, including changes in interest rates, could influence not only the interest the Company receives on loans and securities and the amount of interest it pays on deposits and borrowings, but such changes could also affect (i) the Company’s ability to originate loans and obtain deposits, (ii) the fair value of the Company’s financial assets and liabilities, and (iii) the average duration of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities portfolio. If the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings increase at a faster rate than the interest rates received on loans and other investments, the Company’s net interest income, and therefore earnings, could be adversely affected. Earnings could also be adversely affected if the interest rates received on loans and other investments fall more quickly than the interest rates paid on deposits and other borrowings.
 
Although management believes it has implemented effective asset and liability management strategies to reduce the potential effects of changes in interest rates on the Company’s results of operations, any substantial, unexpected, prolonged change in market interest rates could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. For further discussion related to the Company’s management of interest rate risk, see “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT” beginning on page 49 in “MANAGE­MENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
The Company Is Subject to Lending Risk
There are inherent risks associated with the Company’s lending activities. These risks include, among other things, the impact of changes in interest rates and changes in the economic conditions in the markets where the Company operates, as well as those throughout the United States. Increases in interest rates and/or a return to weakening economic conditions could adversely impact the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans or the value of the collateral securing these loans. The Company is also subject to various laws and regulations that affect its lending activities. Failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations could subject the Company to regulatory enforcement action that could result in the assessment of significant civil money penalties against the Company. In addition, under various laws and regulations relating to mortgage lending and terms of various agreements the Company is a party to, the Company may be required to repurchase loans or indemnify loan purchasers as a result of breaches of representations and warranties, borrower fraud, or certain borrower defaults.
 
As of December 31, 2012, approximately 59.1% of the Company’s loan portfolio consisted of commercial and industrial, factored receivables, construction and commercial real estate loans. These types of loans are generally viewed as having more risk of default than residential real estate loans or consumer loans. These types of loans are also typically larger than residential real estate loans and consumer loans. Because the Company’s loan portfolio contains a significant number of commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loans with relatively large balances, the deterioration of one or a few of these loans could cause a significant increase in nonperforming loans. An increase in nonperforming loans could result in a net loss of earnings from these loans, an increase in the provision for loan losses and an increase in loan charge-offs, all of which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. Further, if repurchase and indemnity demands with respect to the Company’s loan portfolio increase, its liquidity, results of operations and financial condition will be adversely affected. For further discussion related to commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loans, see “Loan Portfolio” beginning on page 40 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
 
PAGE 17

 

The Company’s Allowance for Loan Losses May Be Insufficient
The Company maintains an allowance for loan losses, which is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, that represents management’s best estimate of probable losses that have been incurred within the existing portfolio of loans. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. The level of the allowance reflects management’s continuing evaluation of industry concentrations; specific credit risks; loan loss experience; current loan portfolio quality; present economic, political and regu­latory conditions; and unidentified losses inherent in the current loan portfolio. The determination of the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses inherently involves a high degree of subjectivity and requires the Company to make significant estimates of current credit risks and trends, all of which may undergo material changes. Continuing deterioration of economic conditions affecting borrowers, new information regarding existing loans, identification of additional problem loans and other factors, both within and outside the Company’s control, may require an increase in the allowance for loan losses. In addition, bank regulatory agencies periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses and may require an increase in the provision for loan losses or the recognition of further loan charge-offs, based on judgments different than those of management. In addition, if charge-offs in future periods exceed the allowance for loan losses, the Company will need additional provisions to increase the allowance for loan losses. Any increases in the allowance for loan losses will result in a decrease in net income and, possibly, capital, and may have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations. For further discussion related to the Company’s process for determining the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses, see “Asset Quality” beginning on page 41 in “MAN­AGE­MENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
The Company May Not Be Able to Meet the Cash Flow Requirements of Its Depositors and Borrowers or Meet Its Operating Cash Needs to Fund Corporate Expansion and Other Activities
Liquidity is the ability to meet cash flow needs on a timely basis at a reasonable cost. The liquidity of the bank is used to make loans and leases and to repay deposit liabilities as they become due or are demanded by customers. The overall liquidity position of the bank and the parent company are regularly monitored to ensure that various alternative strategies exist to cover unanticipated events that could affect liquidity. Funding sources include Federal funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements and non-core deposits. The bank is a member of the Federal Home Loan Bank of New York, which provides funding through advances to members that are collateralized with mortgage-related assets. The Company maintains a portfolio of securities that can be used as a secondary source of liquidity. The bank also can borrow through the Federal Reserve Bank’s discount window.
 
If the Company is unable to access any of these funding sources when needed, we might be unable to meet customers’ needs, which could adversely impact our financial condition, results of operations, cash flows, and level of regulatory-qualifying capital. For further discussion, see “Liquidity Risk” beginning on page 51 in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS.”
 
The Parent Company Relies on Dividends from Its Subsidiaries
The parent company is a separate and distinct legal entity from its subsidiaries. It receives dividends from its subsidiaries. These dividends are the principal source of funds to pay dividends on the parent company’s common shares and principal and interest on its debt. Various federal and/or state laws and regulations limit the amount of dividends that the bank and certain nonbank subsidiaries may pay to the parent company. Also, the parent company’s right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors. In the event the bank is unable to pay dividends to the parent company, the parent company may not be able to service debt, pay obligations or pay dividends on the parent company’s common shares. The inability of the parent company to receive dividends from the bank could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. See “SUPERVISION AND REGULA­TION” on pages 3–13 and Note 15 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
The Company May Need to Raise Additional Capital in the Future and Such Capital May Not Be Available When Needed or at All
The Company may need to raise additional capital in the future to provide it with sufficient capital resources and liquidity to meet its commitments and business needs, particularly if its asset quality or earnings were to deteriorate significantly. The Company’s ability to raise additional capital, if needed, will depend on, among other things, conditions in the capital markets at that time, which are outside of the Company’s control, and the Company’s financial performance. Economic conditions and the loss of confidence in financial institutions may increase the Company’s cost of funding and limit access to certain customary sources of capital, including inter-bank borrowings, repurchase agreements and borrowings from the Federal Reserve Bank’s discount window.
 
 
PAGE 18

 
 
The Company cannot assure that such capital will be available on acceptable terms or at all. Any occurrence that may limit the Company’s access to the capital markets, such as a decline in the confidence of debt purchasers, depositors of the bank or counterparties participating in the capital markets, or a downgrade of the parent company or the bank’s ratings, may adversely affect the Company’s capital costs and its ability to raise capital and, in turn, its liquidity. Moreover, if the Company needs to raise capital in the future, it may have to do so when many other financial institutions are also seeking to raise capital and would have to compete with those institutions for investors. An inability to raise additional capital on acceptable terms when needed could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s liquidity business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company Is Subject to a Variety of Operational Risks, Including Reputational Risk, Legal and Compliance Risk, the Risk of Fraud or Theft by Employees or Outsiders
The Company is exposed to many types of operational risks, including reputational risk, legal and compliance risk, the risk of fraud or theft by employees or outsiders, unauthorized transactions by employees or operational errors, including clerical or recordkeeping errors or those resulting from faulty or disabled computer or telecommunications systems. Negative public opinion can result from its actual or alleged conduct in any number of activities, including lending practices, corporate governance and acquisitions and from actions taken by government regulators and community organizations in response to those activities. The 2008 financial crisis and current political and public sentiment regarding financial institutions have resulted in a significant amount of adverse media coverage of financial institutions. Harm to our reputation can result from numerous sources, including adverse publicity arising from events in the financial markets, our perceived failure to comply with legal and regulatory requirements, the purported actions of our employees or alleged financial reporting irregularities involving ourselves or our competitors. In this regard, government authorities, including the bank regulatory agencies, are pursuing aggressive enforcement actions with respect to compliance and other legal matters involving financial activities, which heightens the risks associated with actual and perceived compliance failures. Additionally, a failure to deliver appropriate standards of service and quality or a failure to appropriately describe our products and services can result in customer dissatisfaction, lost revenue, higher operating costs and litigation. Actions by the financial services industry generally or by other members of or individuals in the financial services industry can also negatively impact our reputation. For example, public perception that some consumers may have been treated unfairly by financial institutions has damaged the reputation of the financial services industry as a whole. Negative public opinion can adversely affect its ability to attract and keep customers and can expose the Company to litigation and regulatory action. Actual or alleged conduct by the Company can result in negative public opinion about its other business. Negative public opinion could also affect its credit ratings, which are important to its access to unsecured wholesale borrowings.
 
Because the nature of the financial services business involves a high volume of transactions, certain errors may be repeated or compounded before they are discovered and successfully rectified. The Company’s necessary dependence upon automated systems to record and process its transaction volume may further increase the risk that technical flaws or employee tampering or manipulation of those systems will result in losses that are difficult to detect. The Company also may be subject to disruptions of its operating systems arising from events that are wholly or partially beyond its control (for example, computer viruses or electrical or telecommunications outages), which may give rise to disruption of service to customers and to financial loss or liability. While the Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent or limit the effect of the failure, interruption or security breach of its information systems, there can be no assurance that any such failures, interruptions or security breaches will not occur or, if they do occur, that they will be adequately addressed. The Company is further exposed to the risk that its external vendors may be unable to fulfill their contractual obligations (or will be subject to the same risk of fraud or operational errors by their respective employees as the Company is) and to the risk that its (or its vendors’) business continuity and data security systems prove to be inadequate. The occurrence of any of these risks could result in a diminished ability of the Company to operate its business, potential liability to clients, reputational damage and regulatory intervention, which could adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of operations, perhaps materially.
 
The Company Relies on Other Companies to Provide Key Components of Its Business Infrastructure
Third parties provide key components of the Company’s business infrastructure, for example, system support, Internet connections and network access. While the Company has selected these third-party vendors carefully, it does not control their actions. Any problems caused by these third parties, including those resulting from their failure to provide services for any reason or their poor performance of services, could adversely affect its ability to deliver products and services to its customers and otherwise conduct its business. Replacing these third-party vendors could also entail significant delay and expense.
 
 
PAGE 19

 
 
The Company Is Subject to Environmental Liability Risk Associated with Lending Activities
A portion of the Company’s loan portfolio is secured by real property. During the ordinary course of business, the Company may foreclose on and take title to properties securing certain loans. In doing so, there is a risk that hazardous or toxic substances could be found on these properties. If hazardous or toxic substances are found, the Company may be liable for remediation costs, as well as for personal injury and property damage. Environmental laws may require the Company to incur substantial expense and may materially reduce the affected property’s value or limit the Company’s ability to use or sell the affected property. Future laws or more stringent interpretations or enforcement policies with respect to existing laws may increase the Company’s exposure to environmental liability. Although the Company has policies and procedures to perform an environmental review before initiating any foreclosure action on real property, these reviews may not be sufficient to detect all potential environmental hazards. The remediation costs and any other financial liabilities associated with an environmental hazard could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company’s Profitability Depends Significantly on Local and Overall Economic Conditions
The Company’s success depends significantly on the economic conditions of the communities it serves and the general economic conditions of the United States. The Company has operations in New York City and the New York metropolitan area, and conducts business in Virginia and other mid-Atlantic states and throughout the United States. The economic conditions in these areas and throughout the United States have a significant impact on the demand for the Company’s products and services, as well as the ability of the Company’s customers to repay loans, the value of the collateral securing loans and the stability of the Company’s deposit funding sources. Poor economic conditions, whether caused by recession, inflation, unemployment, changes in securities markets, acts of terrorism, outbreak of hostilities or other international or domestic occurrences, acts of God or other factors could impact these local economic conditions and, in turn, have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company May Be Adversely Affected by the Soundness of Other Financial Institutions
Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. The Company has exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely executes transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including commercial banks, brokers and dealers, investment banks, and other institutional clients. Many of these transactions expose the Company to credit risk in the event of a default by a counterparty or client. In addition, the Company’s credit risk may be exacerbated when the collateral held by the Company cannot be realized upon or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the credit, or derivative, if any, exposure due to the Company. Any such losses could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
Severe Weather, Natural Disasters or Other Acts of God, Acts of War or Terrorism and Other External Events Could Significantly Impact the Company’s Business
Severe weather, natural disasters or other acts of God, acts of war or terrorism and other adverse external events could have a significant impact on the Company’s ability to conduct business. Such events could affect the stability of the Company’s deposit base, impair the ability of borrowers to repay outstanding loans, impair the value of collateral securing loans, cause significant property damage, result in loss of revenue and/or cause the Company to incur additional expenses. Although management has established disaster recovery policies and procedures, the occurrence of any such event could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company Operates in a Highly Competitive Industry and Market Area
The Company faces substantial competition in all areas of its operations from a variety of different competitors, many of which are larger and may have more financial resources. Such competitors primarily include national, regional, and community banks within the various markets the Company operates. Additionally, various out-of-state banks have entered the market areas in which the Company currently operates. The Company also faces competition from many other types of financial institutions, including, without limitation, savings and loan associations, credit unions, finance companies, brokerage firms, insurance companies, factoring companies and other financial intermediaries. The financial services industry could become even more competitive as a result of legislative, regulatory and technological changes and continued consolidation. Also, technology and other changes have lowered barriers to entry and made it possible for nonbanks to offer products and services traditionally provided by banks. For example, consumers can maintain funds that would have historically been held as bank deposits in brokerage accounts or
 
 
PAGE 20

 

mutual funds. The expiration on December 31, 2012 of the FDIC’s unlimited insurance coverage for non-interest-bearing transaction accounts at banking institutions may make it more likely for depositors to move funds into non-bank products. Consumers can also complete transactions such as paying bills and/or transferring funds directly without the assistance of banks. The process of eliminating banks as intermediaries, known as “disintermediation,” could result in the loss of fee income, as well as the loss of customer deposits and the related income generated from those deposits. Many of the Company’s competitors have fewer regulatory constraints and may have lower cost structures. Additionally, due to their size, many competitors may be able to achieve economies of scale and, as a result, may offer a broader range of products and services, as well as better pricing for those products and services than the Company does.
 
The Company’s ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including, among other things:
• The ability to develop, maintain and build upon customer relationships based on top quality service, high ethical standards and safe, sound assets.
• The ability to expand the Company’s market position.
• The scope, relevance and pricing of products and services offered to meet customer needs and demands.
• The rate at which the Company introduces new products and services relative to its competitors.
• Customer satisfaction with the Company’s level of service.
• Industry and general economic trends.
 
Failure to perform in any of these areas could significantly weaken the Company’s competitive position, which could adversely affect the Company’s growth and profitability, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company Is Subject to Extensive Government Regulation and Supervision
The Company, primarily through the parent company and the bank and certain nonbank subsidiaries, is subject to extensive federal and state regulation and supervision. Banking regulations are primarily intended to protect depositors’ funds, federal deposit insurance funds and the banking system as a whole, not shareholders. These regulations affect the Company’s lending practices, capital levels and structure, compensation practices, investment practices, dividend policy and growth, among other things. Congress and federal regulatory agencies continually review banking laws, regulations and policies for possible changes. The Dodd-Frank Act, enacted in July 2010, instituted major changes to the banking and financial institutions’ regulatory regimes. U.S. regulatory agencies—banking, securities and commodities—are steadily publishing notices of proposed and final regulations required by the Dodd-Frank Act, and new bodies created by the Dodd-Frank Act (including the Financial Stability Oversight Council and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau) are commencing operations. The related findings of various regulatory and commission studies, the interpretations issued as part of the rulemaking process, the final regulations that are issued with respect to various elements of the new law and market practices that develop around the final rules may cause changes that impact the profitability of our business activities and cause us to change certain business practices and plans. Other changes to statutes, regulations or regulatory policies, including changes in interpretation or implementation of statutes, regulations or policies, could affect the Company in substantial and unpredictable ways. Such changes could subject the Company to additional costs, limit the types of financial services and products the Company may offer and/or increase the ability of nonbanks to offer competing financial services and products, among other things. Failure to comply with laws, regulations or policies could result in sanctions by regulatory agencies, civil money penalties and/or reputation damage, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. While the Company has policies and procedures designed to prevent any such violations, there can be no assurance that such violations will not occur. See “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” on pages 3–13.
 
Increases in FDIC Insurance Premiums May Adversely Affect the Company’s Earnings
Since 2008, higher levels of bank failures have dramatically increased resolution costs of the FDIC and depleted the DIF. In addition, the increase of insured amount of deposit accounts placed additional stress on the DIF. In order to maintain a strong funding position and restore reserve ratios of the DIF, the FDIC has increased assessment rates of insured institutions.
 
The Company is generally unable to control the amount of premiums that it is required to pay for FDIC insurance. If there are additional bank or financial institution failures the Company may be required to pay even higher FDIC premiums than the recently increased levels. Additionally, the failure by the parent company or the bank to maintain its “well capitalized” status could also lead to higher FDIC
 
 
PAGE 21

 
 
assessments. Such increases and any future increases or required prepayments of FDIC insurance premiums may adversely impact its earnings.
 
The Company’s Controls and Procedures May Fail or Be Circumvented
The Company’s internal controls, disclosure controls and procedures, and corporate governance policies and procedures can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurances that the objectives of the system are met. Any failure or circumvention of the Company’s controls and procedures or failure to comply with regulations related to controls and procedures could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
The Company May Be Subject to a Higher Effective Tax Rate if Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. Fails to Qualify as a Real Estate Investment Trust (“REIT”)
Sterling Real Estate Holding Company Inc. (“SREHC”) operates as a REIT for federal income tax purposes. SREHC was established to acquire, hold and manage mortgage assets and other authorized investments to generate net income for distribution to its shareholders.
 
For an entity to qualify as a REIT, it must satisfy the following six asset tests under the Internal Revenue Code each quarter: (1) 75% of the value of the REIT’s total assets must consist of real estate assets, cash and cash items, and government securities; (2) not more than 25% of the value of the REIT’s total assets may consist of securities, other than those includible under the 75% test; (3) not more than 5% of the value of its total assets may consist of securities of any one issuer, other than those securities includible under the 75% test or securities of taxable REIT subsidiaries; (4) not more than 10% of the outstanding voting power of any one issuer may be held, other than those securities includible under the 75% test or securities of taxable REIT subsidiaries; (5) not more than 10% of the total value of the outstanding securities of any one issuer may be held, other than those securities includible under the 75% test or securities of taxable REIT subsidiaries; and (6) a REIT cannot own securities in one or more taxable REIT subsidiaries, which comprise more than 25% of its total assets. At December 31, 2012, SREHC met all six quarterly asset tests.
 
Also, a REIT must satisfy the following two gross income tests each year: (1) 75% of its gross income must be from qualifying income closely connected with real estate activities; and (2) 95% of its gross income must be derived from sources qualifying for the 75% test plus dividends, interest, and gains from the sale of securities. In addition, a REIT must distribute at least 90% of its taxable income for the taxable year, excluding any net capital gains, to maintain its non-taxable status for federal income tax purposes. For 2012, SREHC had met the two annual income tests and the distribution test.
 
If SREHC fails to meet any of the required provisions and, therefore, does not qualify to be a REIT, the Company’s effective tax rate would increase.
 
The Company Would Be Subject to a Higher Effective Tax Rate if Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. Is Required to Be Included in a New York Combined Return
New York State tax law generally requires a REIT that is majority-owned by a New York State bank to be included in the bank’s combined New York State tax return. The Company believes that it qualifies for the small-bank exception to this rule. If, contrary to this belief, Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. were required to be included in the Company’s New York State combined tax return, the Company’s effective tax rate would increase.
 
Under the small-bank exception, dividends received by the bank from SREHC, a real estate investment trust, are subject to a 60% dividends-received deduction, which results in only 40% of the dividends being subject to New York State tax. Currently, the New York City banking corporation tax operates in the same manner in this respect. The possible reform of the New York State franchise and banking corporation tax laws mentioned below could require SREHC to file a combined New York State return with the Company and substantially eliminate the benefit of the 60% dividends-received deduction by causing generally all of SREHC’s income to be subject to New York State tax as part of the Company’s combined return.
 
The Recent Repeal of Federal Prohibitions on Payment of Interest on Demand Deposits Could Increase the Company’s Interest Expense
All federal prohibitions on the ability of financial institutions to pay interest on demand deposit accounts were repealed as part of the Dodd-Frank Act beginning on July 21, 2011. As a result, some financial institutions commenced offering interest on demand deposits to compete for customers. The Company does not yet know what interest rates other institutions may offer as the market rates begin to increase. The Company’s interest expense will increase and its net interest margin will decrease if it begins offering interest on demand deposits to attract additional customers or maintain current customers, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
 
PAGE 22

 
 
New Lines of Business or New Products and Services May Subject the Company to Additional Risks
The Company may implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of business. There are substantial risks and uncertainties associated with these efforts, particularly in instances where the markets are not fully developed. In developing and marketing new lines of business and/or new products and services, the Company may invest significant time and resources but it may take time for revenues to develop. Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business and/or new products or services may not be achieved and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible. External factors, such as compliance with regulations, competitive alternatives, and shifting market preferences, may also impact the successful implementation of a new line of business or a new product or service. Furthermore, any new line of business and/or new product or service could have a significant impact on the effectiveness of the Company’s system of internal controls. Failure to manage these risks successfully in the development and implementation of new lines of business or new products or services could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition.
 
Potential Acquisitions May Disrupt the Company’s Business and Dilute Shareholder Value
Acquiring other banks, businesses or branches involves various risks commonly associated with acquisitions, including, among other things:
• Potential exposure to unknown or contingent liabilities of the target company.
• Exposure to potential asset quality issues of the target company.
• Difficulty and expense of integrating the operations and personnel of the target company.
• Potential disruption to the Company’s business.
• Potential diversion of the Company’s management time and attention.
• The possible loss of key employees and customers of the target company.
• Difficulty in estimating the value of the target company.
• Potential changes in banking or tax laws or regulations that may affect the target company.
 
To the extent we enter into an agreement to acquire an entity, there can be no guarantee that the transaction will close when anticipated, or at all. In particular, at times we must seek federal regulatory approvals before we can acquire another organization, which can delay or disrupt such acquisitions. Acquisitions typically involve the payment of a premium over book and market values, and, therefore, some dilution of the Company’s tangible book value and net income per common share may occur in connection with any future transaction. Furthermore, failure to realize the expected revenue increases, cost savings, increases in geographic or product presence and/or other projected benefits from an acquisition could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company May Not Be Able to Attract and Retain Skilled People
The Company’s success depends, in large part, on its ability to attract and retain key people. Competition for the best people in most activities engaged in by the Company can be intense, and the Company may not be able to hire people or to retain them. The unexpected loss of services of one or more of the Company’s key personnel could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business because of their skills, knowledge of the Company’s market, years of industry experience and the difficulty of promptly finding qualified replacement personnel. The Company has employment agreements with two of its senior officers.
 
Our ability to attract and retain key executives and other employees may be hindered as a result of regulations applicable to incentive compensation and other aspects of our compensation programs promulgated by the Federal Reserve and other regulators in the United States, regulations on incentive compensation to be promulgated by various U.S. regulators pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act and other existing and potential regulations. These regulations, which include and are expected to include mandatory deferral and clawback requirements, do not and will not apply to some of our competitors and to other institutions with which we compete for talent. Our ability to recruit and retain key talent may be adversely affected by these regulations.
 
 
PAGE 23

 
 
If the Company’s Information Systems Experience an Interruption or Breach in Security that Results in a Loss of Confidential Client Information or Impacts Our Ability to Provide Services to Our Clients, Our Business and Results of Operations May Be Adversely Affected
The Company relies heavily on communications and information systems to conduct its business. The security of our computer systems, software and networks, and those functions that we may outsource, may be vulnerable to breaches, hacker attacks, unauthorized access and misuse, computer viruses and other cyber security risks and events that could result in failures or disruptions in our business, customer relationship management, general ledger, deposit and loan systems. Our businesses that rely heavily on technology are particularly vulnerable to security breaches and technology disruptions. Breaches of security may occur through intentional or unintentional acts by those having authorized or unauthorized access to our or our clients’ or counterparties’ confidential information, including employees and customers, as well as hackers. A breach of security that results in the loss of confidential client information may require us to reimburse clients for data and credit monitoring efforts and would be costly and time-consuming, and may negatively impact our results of operations and reputation. Additionally, security breaches or disruptions of our information system could impact our ability to provide services to our clients, which could expose us to liability for damages, result in the loss of customer business, damage our reputation, subject us to regulatory scrutiny or expose us to civil litigation, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Certain security breaches or other cyber incidents may remain undetected for an extended period of time, which may amplify the damages to our clients and/or us arising from such breaches or incidents. In addition, the failure to upgrade or maintain our computer systems, software and networks, as necessary, could also make us susceptible to breaches and unauthorized access and misuse. During the year, the Company experienced occasional cyber-attacks and attempted breaches, which did not, individually or in the aggregate, have a material impact on the Company. There can be no assurance that any failures, interruptions or security breaches that occur in the future will be adequately addressed. We may be required to expend significant additional resources to modify, investigate or remediate vulnerabilities or other exposures arising from information systems security risks.
 
The Company Depends on the Accuracy and Completeness of Information About Customers and Counterparties
In deciding whether to extend credit or enter into other transactions, the Company may rely on information furnished by or on behalf of customers and counterparties, including financial statements, credit reports and other financial information. The Company may also rely on representations of those customers, counterparties or other third parties, such as independent auditors, as to the accuracy and completeness of that information. Reliance on inaccurate or misleading financial statements, credit reports or other financial information could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business and, in turn, the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company Continually Encounters Technological Change
The financial services industry is continually undergoing rapid technological change with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. The Company’s future success depends, in part, upon its ability to address the needs of customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands, as well as to create additional efficiencies in the Company’s operations. Many of the Company’s competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. The Company may not be able to implement effectively new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing these products and services to its customers. Failure to keep pace successfully with technological change affecting the financial services industry could have a material adverse impact on the Company’s business and, in turn, the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
The Company Is Subject to Claims and Litigation Pertaining to Fiduciary Responsibility and Lender Liability
From time to time, customers may make claims or take legal action pertaining to the Company’s performance of its fiduciary responsibilities. Whether such claims or actions are founded or unfounded, if such claims and legal actions are not resolved in a manner favorable to the Company they could result in significant financial liability and/or adversely affect the market perception of the Company and its products and services, as well as impact customer demand for those products and services. Any fiduciary liability or reputation damage could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.
 
 
PAGE 24

 
 
In addition, in recent years, a number of judicial decisions have upheld the right of borrowers to sue lending institutions on the basis of various evolving legal theories, collectively termed “lender liability.” Generally, lender liability is founded on the premise that a lender has either violated a duty, whether implied or contractual, of good faith and fair dealing owed to the borrower or has assumed a degree of control over the borrower resulting in the creation of a fiduciary duty owed to the borrower or its other creditors or shareholders. Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against the Company or its subsidiaries could materially adversely affect its business, financial condition or results of operations and/or cause significant harm to its reputation.
 
The Company’s Reported Financial Results Depend on Management’s Selection of Accounting Methods and Certain Assumptions and Estimates
The Company’s accounting policies and methods are fundamental to the methods by which the Company records and reports its financial condition and results of operations. Its management must exercise judgment in selecting and applying many of these accounting policies and methods so they comply with generally accepted accounting principles and reflect management’s judgment of the most appropriate manner to report its financial condition and results. In some cases, management must select the accounting policy or method to apply from two or more alternatives, any of which may be reasonable under the circumstances, yet may result in its reporting materially different results than would have been reported under a different alternative.
 
Certain accounting policies are critical to presenting its financial condition and results. They require management to make difficult, subjective or complex judgments about matters that are uncertain. Materially different amounts could be reported under different conditions or using different assumptions or estimates. These critical accounting policies include: the allowance for credit losses; the determination of fair value for financial instruments; the valuation of goodwill and other intangible assets; the accounting for pension and post-retirement benefits and the accounting for income taxes. Because of the uncertainty of estimates involved in these matters, the Company may be required to do one or more of the following: significantly increase the allowance for credit losses and/or sustain credit losses that are significantly higher than the reserve provided; recognize significant impairment on its goodwill and other intangible asset balances; or significantly increase its accrued tax liability.
 
Changes in the Company’s Accounting Policies or in Accounting Standards Could Materially Affect How the Company Reports Its Financial Results and Condition
From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) and SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of the Company’s financial statements. These changes can be hard to predict and can materially impact how the Company records and reports its financial condition and results of operations. In some cases, the Company could be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively, resulting in the Company restating prior period financial statements.
 
RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE PARENT COMPANY’S COMMON SHARES
 
The Parent Company’s Share Price Can Be Volatile
Share price volatility may make it more difficult to resell the parent company’s common shares when desired and at an attractive price. The parent company’s share price can fluctuate significantly in response to a variety of factors, including, among other factors:
• Actual or anticipated variations in quarterly results of operations.
• Recommendations by securities analysts.
• Expectation of or actual equity dilution.
• Operating and share price performance of other companies that investors deem comparable to the Company.
• News reports relating to trends, concerns and other issues in the financial services industry.
• Perceptions in the marketplace regarding the Company and/or its competitors.
• New technology used, or services offered, by competitors.
• Significant acquisitions or business combinations, strategic partnerships, joint ventures or capital commitments by or involving the Company or its competitors.
• Failure to integrate acquisitions or realize anticipated bene­fits from acquisitions.
• Changes in government regulation.
• Geopolitical conditions such as acts or threats of terrorism or military conflicts.
 
General market fluctuations, industry factors and general economic and political conditions and events, such as economic slowdowns or recessions, interest rate changes or credit loss trends, could also cause the parent company’s share price to decrease regardless of operating results.
 
 
PAGE 25

 
 
The Trading Volume in the Parent Company’s Common Shares Is Less Than That of Other Larger Financial Services Companies
Although the parent company’s common shares are listed for trading on the NYSE, the trading volume in its common shares is less than that of other larger financial services companies. A public trading market having the desired characteristics of depth, liquidity and orderliness depends on the presence in the marketplace of willing buyers and sellers of the parent company’s common shares at any given time. This presence depends on the individual decisions of investors and general economic and market conditions over which the Company has no control. Given the trading volume of the parent company’s common shares, significant sales of the parent company’s common shares, or the expectation of these sales, could cause the parent company’s share price to fall.
 
An Investment in the Parent Company’s Common Shares Is Not an Insured Deposit
The parent company’s common shares are not bank deposits and, therefore, are not insured against loss by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity. Investment in the parent company’s common shares is inherently risky for the reasons described in this “Risk Factors” section and elsewhere in this report and is subject to the same market forces that affect the price of common shares in any company. As a result, if you acquire the parent company’s common shares, you may lose some or all of your investment.
 
The Parent Company’s Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws as Well as Certain Banking Laws May Have an Anti-Takeover Effect
Provisions of the parent company’s certificate of incorporation and by-laws, and federal banking laws, including regulatory approval requirements, could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire the parent company, even if doing so would be perceived to be beneficial to the parent company’s shareholders. The combination of these provisions effectively inhibits a non-negotiated merger or other business combination, which, in turn, could adversely affect the market price of the parent company’s common shares.
 
The Parent Company May Not Pay Dividends on Its Common Shares
Holders of shares of the parent company’s common shares are only entitled to receive such dividends as its board of directors may declare out of funds legally available for such payments. Although the parent company has historically declared cash dividends on its common shares, it is not required to do so and may reduce or eliminate its common share dividend in the future. This could adversely affect the market price of its common shares.
 
Future Issuances of Additional Common Shares or Other Equity Securities Could Result in Dilution of Ownership of the Parent Company’s Existing Shareholders
The parent company may from time to time explore capital raising opportunities and may determine to issue additional common shares or other equity securities to increase its capital, support growth, or to make acquisitions. We intend to take advantage of favorable market conditions to increase our capital. Further, the parent company may issue stock options or other stock grants to retain and motivate its employees. These issuances of equity securities could dilute the voting and economic interests of its existing shareholders.
 
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
 
None.
 
ITEM 2. PROPERTIES
 
The principal office of the Company occupies one floor at 650 Fifth Avenue, New York, N.Y., consisting of approximately 14,400 square feet. The lease for this office expires April 30, 2016. Rental commitments to the expiration date approximate $3.0 million.
 
At December 31, 2012, the bank also maintains operating leases for 12 branch offices, the international banking facility, and additional space in New York City, Nassau, Suffolk and Westchester counties (New York) with an aggregate of approximately 135 thousand square feet. The aggregate office rental commitments for these premises approximate $41.0 million. These leases have expiration dates ranging from 2013 through 2025 with varying renewal options. The bank owns free and clear (not subject to a mortgage) a building in which it maintains a branch located in Forest Hills, Queens, N.Y.
 
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
In the normal course of business there are various legal proceedings pending against the Company. Management, after consulting with counsel, is of the opinion that there is currently no liability that is probable and can be reasonably estimated with respect to such proceedings and accordingly no provision has been made in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. During the 2011 fourth quarter, the Company recorded a charge related to the settlement of certain litigation.
 
 
PAGE 26

 

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
 
Not applicable.
 
ITEM 4A. SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS
 
No matter was submitted to a vote of security holders in the fourth quarter of the fiscal year covered by this report.
 
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT
 
This table sets forth information regarding the parent company’s executive officers:
 
Name of Executive
 
Title
 
Age
 
Held Executive
Office Since
Louis J. Cappelli
 
Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer, Director
 
82
 
1967
John C. Millman
 
President, Director
 
70
 
1986
John W. Tietjen
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
 
68
 
1989
Howard M. Applebaum
 
Senior Vice President
 
54
 
2002
Eliot S. Robinson
 
Executive Vice President of Sterling National Bank
 
70
 
1998
 
All executive officers who are employees of the parent company are elected annually by the Board of Directors and serve at the pleasure of the Board. The executive officer who is not an employee of the parent company is elected annually by, and serves at the pleasure of, the Board of Directors of the bank. There are no arrangements or understandings between any of the foregoing executive officers and any other person or persons pursuant to which he was selected as an executive officer.
 
PART II
 
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED SHAREHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
 
The parent company’s common shares are traded on the NYSE under the symbol “STL.” Information regarding the quarterly prices of the common shares is presented in Note 24 on page 112. Information regarding the average common shares outstanding and dividends per common share is presented in the Consolidated Statements of Income on page 58. Information regarding the Company’s stock incentive plans is presented in Note 16 on page 94. Information regarding legal restrictions on the ability of the bank to pay dividends is presented in Note 15 on page 94. Although such restrictions do not apply to the payment of dividends by the parent company to its shareholders, such dividends may be limited by other factors, such as the requirement to maintain adequate capital under the risk-based capital regulations described in Note 21 beginning on page 108. As of February 15, 2013, there were 1,162 shareholders of record of our common shares.
 
During the fiscal years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011, the following dividends were declared on our common shares:
 
Cash Dividends Per Share
 
2012
   
2011
 
First Quarter
  $ 0.09     $ 0.09  
Second Quarter
    0.09       0.09  
Third Quarter
    0.09       0.09  
Fourth Quarter
    0.09       0.09  
Total
  $ 0.36     $ 0.36  
 
The Board of Directors initially authorized the repurchase of common shares in 1997 and since then has approved increases in the number of common shares that the parent company is authorized to repurchase. The latest increase was announced on February 15, 2007, when the Board of Directors increased the Company’s authority to repurchase common shares by an additional 800,000 shares. This increased the Company’s authority to repurchase shares to approximately 933,000 common shares.
 
Under its share repurchase program, the Company buys back common shares from time to time. The Company did not repurchase any of its common shares during the fourth quarter of 2012. At December 31, 2012, the maximum number of shares that may yet be repurchased under the share repurchase program was 870,963. Share repurchases are subject to the oversight of the Company’s banking regulators.
 
 
PAGE 27

 
 
For information regarding securities authorized for issuance under the Company’s equity compensation plan, see Item 12 on page 117. The following performance graph compares for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011 and 2012 (a) the yearly cumulative total shareholder return (i.e., the change in share price plus the cumulative amount of dividends, assuming dividend reinvestment, divided by the initial share price, expressed as a percentage) on Sterling’s common shares, with (b) the cumulative total return of the Standard & Poor’s 500 Stock Index, and with (c) the cumulative total return on the KBW Regional Banks Index (a market-capitalization weighted bank-stock index):
 

*$100 invested in 12/31/07 in stock or index, including reinvestment of dividends. Fiscal year ending December 31.

                                                 
      12/07       12/08       12/09       12/10       12/11       12/12  
Sterling Bancorp
    100.00       108.78       59.29       90.33       77.78       85.20  
S&P 500
    100.00       63.00       79.67       91.67       93.61       108.59  
KRX-KBW Regional Bank Index
    100.00       81.44       63.41       76.35       72.43       82.02  
 
ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
The information appears on page 29. All such information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto and discussions of factors that may materially affect the comparability of information and material uncertainties in “MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS—FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS AND FACTORS THAT COULD AFFECT FUTURE RESULTS” on page 30.
 
ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
The information appears on pages 30–55 and supplementary quarterly data appears in Note 24 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements. All such information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto.
 
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
 
The information appears on pages 49–52 under the caption “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT.” All such information should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and notes thereto.
 
 
PAGE 28

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA[1]
 
(dollars in thousands except per share data)
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
SUMMARY OF OPERATIONS
                             
Total interest income
  $ 104,895     $ 99,665     $ 100,252     $ 107,261     $ 119,092  
Total interest expense
    10,981       12,987       15,583       19,295       33,388  
Net interest income
    93,914       86,678       84,669       87,966       85,704  
Provision for loan losses
    10,250       12,000       28,500       27,900       8,325  
Net securities gains
    1,813       2,491       3,928       5,561        
Other-than-temporary losses
                            (1,684 )
Noninterest income, excluding net securities gains and other-than-temporary losses
    38,960       38,407       39,899       36,407       33,361  
Noninterest expenses
    95,884       93,784       90,812       87,704       83,874  
Income before taxes
    28,553       21,792       9,184       14,330       25,182  
Provision for income taxes
    8,537       4,196       2,158       4,908       9,176  
Net income
    20,016       17,596       7,026       9,422       16,006  
Dividends on preferred shares and accretion
          2,074       2,589       2,773       102  
Net income available to common shareholders
    20,016       15,522       4,437       6,649       15,904  
Net income available to common shareholders
                                       
 Per average common share—basic
    0.65       0.51       0.18       0.37       0.89  
—diluted
    0.65       0.51       0.18       0.37       0.88  
Dividends per common share
    0.36       0.36       0.36       0.56       0.76  
YEAR END BALANCE SHEETS
                                       
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    112,886       126,448       40,503       36,958       13,949  
Investment securities
    683,245       677,871       789,315       737,065       793,924  
Loans held for sale
    121,237       43,372       32,049       33,889       23,403  
Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts
    1,649,753       1,473,309       1,314,234       1,195,415       1,184,585  
Total assets
    2,750,842       2,493,297       2,360,457       2,165,609       2,179,101  
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
    924,351       765,800       570,290       546,337       464,585  
Savings, NOW and money market deposits
    701,692       565,423       562,207       592,015       564,205  
Time deposits
    642,041       657,848       615,267       442,315       329,034  
Short-term borrowings
    48,295       65,798       60,894       131,854       363,404  
Advances—FHLB and long-term debt
    127,039       148,507       169,947       155,774       175,774  
Shareholders’ equity
    228,090       220,821       222,742       161,950       160,480  
AVERAGE BALANCE SHEETS
                                       
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    58,836       93,561       31,960       36,804       5,727  
Investment securities
    755,399       850,997       768,184       719,485       744,169  
Loans held for sale
    49,358       27,954       35,354       41,225       23,286  
Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts
    1,534,478       1,351,407       1,227,049       1,154,041       1,120,362  
Total assets
    2,576,815       2,508,184       2,244,569       2,114,221       2,066,628  
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
    782,771       596,608       489,184       441,087       427,105  
Savings, NOW and money market deposits
    653,292       596,007       564,061       562,780       522,807  
Time deposits
    645,745       729,053       559,203       375,742       451,031  
Short-term borrowings
    66,874       77,143       112,207       271,075       279,840  
Advances—FHLB and long-term debt
    139,067       155,332       158,351       174,981       163,479  
Shareholders’ equity
    227,619       224,820       213,153       158,225       119,791  
RATIOS
                                       
Return on average total assets
    0.78 %     0.70 %     0.31 %     0.45 %     0.77 %
Return on average shareholders’ equity
    8.79       7.83       3.30       5.95       13.36  
Dividend payout ratio
    55.62       63.21       126.29       107.52       85.43  
Average shareholders’ equity to average total assets
    8.83       8.96       9.50       7.48       5.80  
Net interest margin (tax-equivalent basis)
    4.17       4.01       4.40       4.70       4.65  
Loans/assets, year end[2]
    64.38       60.83       57.03       56.77       55.44  
Net charge-offs/loans, year end[3]
    0.47       0.69       2.25       1.95       0.54  
Nonperforming loans/loans, year end[2]
    0.33       0.42       0.49       1.46       0.61  
Allowance/loans, year end[3]
    1.35       1.36       1.39       1.66       1.35  
Allowance/nonaccrual loans
    377.36       315.02       274.50       110.54       218.00  

[1] Certain reclassifications have been made to prior years’ financial data to conform to current financial statement presentations.
[2] In this calculation, the term “loans” means loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio.
[3] In this calculation, the term “loans” means loans held in portfolio.
 
 
PAGE 29

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
The following commentary presents management’s discus­sion and analysis of the financial condition and results of operations of Sterling Bancorp, a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999, and its subsidiaries, principally Sterling National Bank. Throughout this discussion and analysis, the term the “Company” refers to Sterling Bancorp and its consolidated subsidiaries and the term the “bank” refers to Sterling National Bank and its consolidated subsidiaries, while the term the “parent company” refers to Sterling Bancorp but not its subsidiaries. This discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and selected financial data contained elsewhere in this annual report. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior years’ financial data to conform to ­current financial statement presentations. Throughout management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations, dollar amounts in tables are presented in thousands, except per share data.
 
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS AND FACTORS THAT COULD AFFECT FUTURE RESULTS
 
Certain statements contained or incorporated by reference in this annual report on Form 10-K, including but not limited to, statements concerning future results of operations or financial position, borrowing capacity and future liquidity, future investment results, future credit exposure, future loan losses and plans and objectives for future operations, change in laws and regulations applicable to the Company, adequacy of funding sources, actuarial expected benefit payment, valuation of foreclosed assets, our ability to hold to maturity securities designated as held to maturity, regulatory requirements, economic environment and other statements contained herein regarding matters that are not historical facts, are “forward-looking statements” as defined in the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. These statements are not historical facts but instead are subject to numerous assumptions, risks and uncertainties, and represent only our belief regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control. Any forward-looking statements the Company may make speak only as of the date on which such statements are made. Our actual results and financial position may differ materially from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in or implied by these forward-looking statements, and the Company makes no commitment to update or revise forward-looking statements in order to reflect new information or subsequent events or changes in expectations.
 
Factors that could cause our actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, the following: inflation, interest rates, market and monetary fluctuations; geopolitical developments including acts of war and terrorism and their impact on economic conditions; the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary and fiscal policies and laws, including interest rate policies of the Federal Reserve Board; changes, particularly declines, in general economic conditions and in the local economies in which the Company operates; the financial condition of the Company’s borrowers; competitive pressures on loan and deposit pricing and demand; changes in technology and their impact on the marketing of new products and services and the acceptance of these products and services by new and existing customers; the willingness of customers to substitute competitors’ products and services for the Company’s products and services; the impact of changes in financial services laws and regulations (including laws concerning taxes, banking, securities and insurance); changes in accounting principles, policies and guidelines; the risks and uncertainties described in ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS on pages 15–26; other risks and uncertainties described from time to time in press releases and other public filings; and the Company’s performance in managing the risks involved in any of the foregoing. The foregoing list of important factors is not exclusive, and the Company will not update any forward-looking statement, whether written or oral, that may be made from time to time.
 
RECENT REGULATORY DEVELOPMENTS
 
On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed into law Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”). The Dodd-Frank Act has resulted, and will continue to result, in sweeping changes in the regulation of financial institutions aimed at strengthening the sound operation of the financial services sector. Certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that affect all banks and bank holding companies include: (i) creation of the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, responsible for implementing, examining and enforcing compliance with federal consumer protection laws; (ii) limitation on the preemption of state banking law by federal law; (iii) application of the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to most bank holding companies; (iv) making capital requirements for national banks counter-cyclical; (v) imposition of “well capitalized” and “well managed” requirements to bank holding companies and restricting out-of-state
 
 
PAGE 30

 

 
acquisition by bank holding companies and banks that do not meet such standards; (vi) implementation of corporate governance revisions, (vii) making permanent the federal deposit insurance limit per customer and implementing certain measures to strengthen the Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”), (viii) repeal of the federal prohibition on the payment of interest on demand deposits, (ix) prohibition on banking entities from engaging in proprietary trading or acquiring or retaining an interest in a private equity or hedge fund (the “Volcker Rule”), and (x) increase of the Federal Reserve’s supervisory authority, among others.
 
In October 2011, federal regulators proposed rules to implement the Volcker Rule. The proposed rules are highly complex, and many aspects of the Volcker Rule remain unclear. Companies are expected to be required to be in compliance by July 2014 (subject to possible extension).
 
Many of the Dodd-Frank Act’s provisions are subject to final rulemaking by the U.S. financial regulatory agencies, and the implications of the Dodd-Frank Act for the Company’s business will depend to a large extent on how such rules are adopted and implemented by the primary U.S. financial regulatory agencies. The Company continues to analyze the impact of rules adopted under the Dodd-Frank Act on the Company’s businesses. However, the full impact will not be known until the rules, and other regulatory initiatives that overlap with the rules, are finalized and their combined impact can be understood.
 
In June 2012, the Company’s primary federal regulator, the Federal Reserve Board, published two notices of proposed rulemaking (the “2012 Capital Proposals”) that would substantially revise the risk-based capital requirements applicable to bank holding companies and depository institutions, including the parent company and the bank, compared to the current U.S. risk-based capital rules, which are based on the aforementioned Basel I capital accords of the Basel Committee. One of the 2012 Capital Proposals (the “Basel III Proposal”) addresses the components of capital and other issues affecting the numerator in banking institutions’ regulatory capital ratios and would implement the Basel Committee’s December 2010 framework known as “Basel III” for strengthening international capital standards. The other proposal (the “Standardized Approach Proposal”) addresses risk weights and other issues affecting the denominator in banking institutions’ regulatory capital ratios and would replace the existing Basel I-derived risk-weighting approach with a more risk-sensitive approach based, in part, on the standardized approach in the Basel Committee’s 2004 “Basel II” capital accords. The 2012 Capital Proposals would also implement the requirements of Section 939A of the Dodd-Frank Act to remove references to credit ratings from the federal banking agencies’ rules. As proposed, the Basel III Proposal and the Standardized Approach Proposal would come into effect on January 1, 2013 (subject to a phase-in period) and January 1, 2015 (with an option for early adoption), respectively; however, final rules have not yet been adopted, and the Basel III framework is therefore not yet applicable to the parent company and the bank.
 
The Basel III Proposal, among other things, (i) introduces as a new capital measure “Common Equity Tier 1” (“CET1”), (ii) specifies that Tier 1 capital consists of CET1 and “Additional Tier 1 capital” instruments meeting specified requirements, (iii) defines CET1 narrowly by requiring that most adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital and (iv) expands the scope of the adjustments as compared to existing regulations.
 
For more detailed discussion on recent legislative and regulatory developments, including the Dodd-Frank Act and increased capital and liquidity requirements, see “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” on pages 3–13.
 
CRITICAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND ESTIMATES
 
The accounting and reporting policies followed by the Company conform, in all material respects, to U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“U.S. GAAP”). In preparing the ­consolidated financial statements, management has made estimates, assumptions and judgments based on information available as of the date of the financial statements; accordingly, as this information changes, the financial statements may reflect different estimates, assumptions and judgments. Certain policies inherently have greater reliance on the use of estimates, assumptions and judgments and, as such, have a greater possibility of producing results that could be materially different than originally reported. Estimates, assumptions and judgments are necessary when assets and liabilities are required to be recorded at fair value, when a decline in the value of an asset not carried on the financial statements at fair value warrants an impairment write-down or valuation allowance to be established, or when an asset or liability must be recorded contingent upon a future event. Carrying assets and liabilities at fair value inherently results in more
 
 
PAGE 31

 
 
financial statement volatility. The fair values and the information used to record valuation adjustments for certain assets and liabilities are based either on quoted market prices or are provided by other third-party sources, when readily available. Management evaluates its estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis using historical experience and other ­factors, including the current economic environment, which management believes to be reasonable under the circumstances. The Company adjusts such estimates and assumptions when the Company believes facts and circumstances dictate. Illiquid credit markets, volatile equity, foreign currency and energy markets and declines in consumer spending have combined to increase the uncertainty inherent in such estimates and assumptions. As future events and their effects cannot be determined with precision, actual results could differ significantly from these estimates. Changes in those estimates resulting from continuing changes in the economic environment will be reflected in the financial statements in the future periods.
 
The Company’s accounting policies are fundamental to understanding management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations. The most significant accounting policies followed by the Company are presented in Note 1 begin­ning on page 63. The accounting for factoring transactions also is discussed under “BUSINESS OPERA­TIONS —The Bank—Commercial Lending, Asset-Based Financing, Residential Mortgage Warehouse Lending and Factoring/Accounts Receivable Management” on pages 1 and 2.
 
The Company has identified its policies on the valuation of securities, the allowance for loan losses and income tax liabilities to be critical because management has to make subjective and/or complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain and could be subject to revision as new information becomes available. Additional information on these policies can be found in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.
 
Management utilizes various inputs to determine the fair value of its securities portfolio. Fair value of securities is based upon market prices, where available (Level 1 inputs). If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon market prices determined by an outside, independent entity that primarily uses, as inputs, observable market-based parameters (Level 2 inputs). Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. These adjustments may include amounts to reflect counterparty credit quality and the Company’s creditworthiness, among other things, as well as unobservable parameters (Level 3 inputs). Any such valuation adjustments are applied consistently over time. The Company’s valuation methodologies may produce a fair value calculation that may not be indicative of net realized value or reflective of future fair values. While management believes the Company’s valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date. Additional discussion of valuation methodologies is presented in Note 20 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
A periodic review is conducted by management to determine if the decline in the fair value of any security appears to be other-than-temporary. Factors considered in determining whether the decline is other-than-temporary include, but are not limited to: the length of time and the extent to which fair value has been below cost; the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer; and the Company’s intent to sell. If the decline is deemed to be other-than-temporary, and the Company does not have the intent to sell, and will not likely be required to sell, the security is written down to a new cost basis and the resulting credit component of the loss is reported in noninterest income and the remainder of the loss is recorded in shareholders’ equity. If the Company intends to sell or will be required to sell, the full amount of the other-than-temporary impairment is recorded in noninterest income. Additional discussion of management’s evaluation process and other-than-temporary-impairment charges is presented in Note 1 and in Note 4.
 
The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio. Determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses is considered a critical accounting estimate because it requires significant judgment and the use of estimates related to the amount and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, estimated losses on pools of homogeneous loans based on historical loss experience, and consideration of current economic trends and conditions, all of which may be susceptible to significant change. The methodology used to determine the allowance for loan losses is outlined in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements and a discussion of the factors driving changes in the amount of the allowance for loan losses is included under the caption “Asset Quality” beginning on page 41.
 
 
PAGE 32

 
 
The objectives of accounting for income taxes are to recognize the amount of taxes payable or refundable for the current year and deferred tax liabilities and assets for the future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in an entity’s financial statements or tax returns. Judgment is required in assessing the future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in the Company’s consolidated financial statements or tax returns. Fluctuations in the actual outcome of these future tax consequences could impact the Company’s consolidated financial condition or results of operations. In connection with determining its income tax provision under Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“Codification”) Topic 740: Income Taxes, the Company maintains a reserve related to certain tax positions and strategies that management believes contain an element of uncertainty. The Company evaluates each of its tax positions and strategies periodically to determine whether the reserve continues to be appropriate. Additional discussion on the accounting for income taxes is presented in Note 1 and in Note 18 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
OVERVIEW
 
The Company provides a broad range of banking and financial products and services, including business and consumer lending, asset-based financing, residential mortgage warehouse funding, factoring/accounts receivable management services, equipment financing, commercial and residential mortgage lending and brokerage, deposit services and trade financing. The Company has operations in the New York metropolitan area and conducts business throughout the United States. The general state of the U.S. economy and, in particular, economic and market conditions in the New York metropolitan area have a significant impact on loan demand, the ability of borrowers to repay these loans and the value of any collateral securing these loans and may also affect deposit levels. Accordingly, future general economic conditions are a key uncertainty that management expects will materially affect the Company’s results of operations.
 
In 2012, the bank’s average earning assets represented approximately 99.3% of the Company’s average earning assets. Loans represented 65.7% and investment securities represented 31.5% of the bank’s average earning assets in 2012.
 
The Company’s primary source of earnings is net interest income, and its principal market risk exposure is interest rate risk. The Federal Reserve Board influences the general market rates of interest, including the deposit and loan rates offered by many financial institutions. The Company’s loan portfolio is significantly affected by changes in the prime interest rate. The prime interest rate, which is the rate offered on loans to borrowers with strong credit, remained at 3.25% during 2012, 2011 and 2010. The intended federal funds rate, which is the cost of immediately available overnight funds, remained at zero to 0.25% during 2012, 2011 and 2010. The Company’s balance sheet has historically been asset sensitive, meaning that earning assets generally reprice more quickly than interest-bearing liabilities. Therefore, the Company’s net interest margin is likely to increase in sustained periods of rising interest rates and decrease in sustained periods of declining interest rates. The Company is not able to predict market interest rate fluctuations and its asset/liability management strategy may not prevent interest rate changes from having a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.
 
Although management endeavors to minimize the credit risk inherent in the Company’s loan portfolio, it must necessarily make various assumptions and judgments about the collectibility of the loan portfolio based on its experience and evaluation of economic conditions. If such assumptions or judgments prove to be incorrect, the current allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover loan losses and additions to the allowance may be necessary, which would have a negative impact on net income.
 
There is intense competition in all areas in which the Company conducts its business. The Company competes with banks and other financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings banks, finance companies and credit unions. Many of these competitors have substantially greater resources and lending limits and provide a wider array of banking ser­vices. To a limited extent, the Company also competes with other providers of financial services, such as money market mutual funds, brokerage firms, consumer finance companies and insurance companies. Competition is based on a number of factors, including prices, interest rates, services, availability of products and geographic location.
 
 
PAGE 33

 
 
Taxable-equivalent adjustments are the result of increasing income from tax-free loans and investments by an amount equal to the taxes that would be paid if the income were fully taxable-based on a 35% federal tax rate, thus making tax-exempt yields comparable to taxable asset yields.
 
INCOME STATEMENT ANALYSIS
 
Net interest income, which represents the difference between interest earned on interest-earning assets and interest incurred on interest-bearing liabilities, is the Company’s primary source of earnings. Net interest income can be affected by changes in market interest rates as well as the level and composition of assets, liabilities and shareholders’ equity. Net interest spread is the difference between the average rate earned, on a tax-equivalent basis, on interest-earning assets and the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities. The net yield on ­interest-earning assets (“net interest margin”) is calculated by dividing tax equivalent net interest income by average interest-earning assets. Generally, the net interest margin will exceed the net interest spread because a portion of interest-earning assets are funded by various noninterest-bearing sources, principally noninterest-bearing deposits and shareholders’ equity. The increases (decreases) in the components of interest income and interest expense, expressed in terms of fluctuation in average volume and rate, are provided in the RATE/VOLUME ANALYSIS shown on page 48. Information as to the components of interest income and interest expense and average rates is provided in the AVERAGE BALANCE SHEETS shown on page 47.
 
COMPARISON OF THE YEARS 2012 AND 2011
 
The Company reported net income available to common shareholders for 2012 of $20.0 million, representing $0.65 per share calculated on a diluted basis, compared to $15.5 million, or 0.51 per share calculated on a diluted basis, for 2011. The increase in net income available to common shareholders was primarily due to a $7.2 million increase in net interest income, a $1.8 million decrease in the provision for loan losses and a $2.1 million decrease in dividend and accretion on the preferred shares, resulting from the repurchase in the second quarter of 2011 of all of the preferred shares and the warrant issued under the TARP Capital Purchase Program. Those benefits were partially offset by a $0.1 million decrease in noninterest income, a $2.1 million increase in noninterest expenses and a $4.3 million increase in the provision for income taxes.
 
Net Interest Income
Net interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, was $97.3 million for 2012 compared to $90.1 million for 2011. Net interest income benefited from higher average loan balances, lower interest-bearing liabilities balances and lower cost of funding. Net interest income also benefited from the reclassification from accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees into interest income from loans of revenues related to one of the Company’s lending products, thereby more appropriately reflecting the characteristics of the product. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform with the current presentation. Those benefits were partially offset by the impact of lower yields on investment securities and loans and lower average investment securities balances. The net interest margin, on a tax-equivalent basis, was 4.17% for 2012 compared to 4.01% for 2011. As discussed in detail below, the net interest margin was impacted by the mix of earning assets and funding, including the higher level of noninterest-bearing demand deposits. See page 47 for the tax-equivalent adjustment to net interest income.
 
Total interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, aggregated $108.3 million for 2012, up $5.2 million from 2011 as the benefit of higher average loan balances more than offset the impact of lower investment securities balances and lower yields. Total interest earning assets increased to $2,406.1 million for 2012 compared to $2,332.7 million for 2011. The tax-equivalent yield on interest-earning assets was 4.64% for 2012 compared to 4.58% for 2011.
 
Interest earned on the loan portfolio increased to $84.0 million for 2012 from $75.3 million in 2011. Average loan balances amounted to $1,583.8 million for 2012, an increase of $204.4 million from an average of $1,379.4 million in 2011. The increase in average loans, primarily due to the Company’s business development activities, accounted for a $12.2 million increase in interest earned on loans. The yield on the loan portfolio decreased to 5.56% for 2012 from 5.81% for 2011, which was primarily attributable to the mix of average outstanding balances among the components of the loan portfolio.
 
Interest earned on the securities portfolio, on a tax-equivalent basis, decreased to $23.8 million for 2012 from $27.2 million in 2011. Average outstandings decreased to $755.4 million (31.4% of average earning assets) for 2012 from $851.0 million (36.5% of average earning assets) in 2011. The average yield on investment securities decreased to 3.14% for 2012 from 3.20% in the corresponding 2011 period. The decrease in balances and decrease in yield reflect
 
 
PAGE 34

 
 
the Company’s decision to replace a portion of medium term (approximate 5 year original maturities), lower yielding U.S. Government Agency Securities that were called by the issuer with longer term (approximate 10-15 year original maturities) U.S. Government Agency securities having approximately the same or slightly higher yield thereby maintaining a pool of pledgable collateral. Management’s Asset/Liability strategy continues to be designed to maintain a portfolio of corporate securities with a relatively short-term average life positioning the Company for higher interest rates in future periods. This strategy was implemented through the sale of available for sale securities, principally longer dated corporate securities and selected obligations of states and political subdivisions with longer average lives.
 
Total interest expense decreased by $2.0 million for 2012 from $13.0 million for 2011, due to the impact of lower balances and rates paid for interest-bearing liabilities.
 
Interest expense on deposits decreased to $6.7 million for 2012 from $8.4 million for 2011, due to decreases in the cost of those funds, coupled with the impact of changes in the mix. The average rate paid on interest-bearing deposits was 0.52%, which was 12 basis points lower than the prior year period. The decrease in average cost of deposits reflects the impact of deposit pricing strategies for NOW, Money market and certificates of deposit that are rolled over at their maturity date and the Company’s purchase of certificates of deposit from various listing services and investment advisors which provided certificate of deposit balances at lower rates. Average interest-bearing deposits were $1,299.0 million for 2012 compared to $1,325.1 million for 2011.
 
Interest expense on borrowings decreased to $4.2 million for 2012 from $4.5 million for 2011, primarily due to lower average balances. Average borrowings decreased to $205.9 million for 2012 from $232.5 million in 2011, reflecting a lesser reliance by the Company on wholesale borrowed funds.
 
Provision for Loan Losses
Based on management’s continuing evaluation of the loan portfolio (discussed under “Asset Quality” beginning on page 41), the provision for loan losses for 2012 was $10.3 million, compared to $12.0 million for the prior year. Factors affecting the provision for the year 2012 included current economic conditions and a lower level of net charge-offs and lower nonaccrual loan balances.
 
The level of the allowance reflects changes in the size of the portfolio or in any of its components as well as management’s continuing evaluation of industry concentrations, specific credit risks, loan loss experience, current loan portfolio quality and economic, political and regulatory conditions. Portions of the allowance may be allocated for specific credits; however, the entire allowance is available for any credit that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. While management utilizes its best judgment and information available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including the performance of the Company’s loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward loan classifications.
 
As of December 31, 2012, the allowance for loan losses increased to $22.3 million from $20.0 million at December 31, 2011, primarily due to a lower level of equipment finance net charge-offs.
 
Noninterest Income
Noninterest income decreased to $40.8 million for 2012 from $40.9 million in 2011. The decrease principally resulted from lower accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other related fees and securities gains partially offset by higher mortgage banking income. Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other related fees were negatively impacted by the level and mix of sales volume and by lower trade finance volume. Mortgage banking income increased principally due to higher volume of loans sold.
 
Noninterest Expense
Noninterest expenses were $95.9 million for 2012, compared to $93.8 million for 2011. Higher compensation expense, reflecting the Company’s continued investment in the franchise, were partially offset by reductions in deposit insurance premiums.
 
Provision for Income Taxes
Reflecting an increase in pre-tax income of $6.8 million, the provision for income taxes for the year 2012 was $8.5 million, reflecting an effective tax rate of 29.9%, compared with $4.2 million for 2011, reflecting an effective tax rate of 19.3%. The increase in the effective tax rate was primarily due to a higher level of pre-tax income in the 2012 period compared to the 2011 period. In 2011, the level of the provision and the effective tax rate also included a net benefit recognized of $1.9 million in the fourth quarter as the result of the completion of federal tax audits for the periods 2002 through 2009.
 
 
PAGE 35

 
 
COMPARISON OF THE YEARS 2011 AND 2010
 
The Company reported net income available to common shareholders for 2011 of $15.5 million, representing $0.51 per share calculated on a diluted basis, compared to $4.4 million, or $0.18 per share calculated on a diluted basis, for 2010. The $11.1 million increase in net income available to common shareholders was primarily due to a $2.0 million increase in net interest income, a $16.5 million decrease in the provision for loan losses and a $0.5 million decrease in dividends and accretion related to the preferred shares issued to the U.S. Treasury under the TARP Capital Purchase Program, which more than offset a $2.9 million decrease in noninterest income, a $3.0 million increase in noninterest expenses and a $2.0 million higher provision for income taxes.
 
Net Interest Income
Net interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, was $90.1 million for 2011 compared to $87.3 million for 2010. Net interest income benefited from higher average loan and investment securities balances and lower cost of funding. Partially offsetting those benefits was the impact of lower yield on loans and investment securities and higher interest-bearing deposit balances. The net interest margin, on a tax-equivalent basis, was 4.01% for 2011 compared to 4.40% for 2010. The net interest margin was impacted by the lower interest rate environment in 2011, the higher level of noninterest-bearing demand deposits and the effect of higher average loans outstanding.
 
Total interest income, on a tax-equivalent basis, aggregated $103.1 million for 2011, compared to $102.9 million from 2010. The tax-equivalent yield on interest-earning assets was 4.58% for 2011 compared to 5.19% for 2010.
 
Interest earned on the loan portfolio increased to $75.3 million for 2011 from $73.2 million for the prior year period. Average loan balances amounted to $1,379.4 million, an increase of $117.0 million from an average of $1,262.4 million in the prior year period. The increase in average loans, primarily due to the Company’s business development activities, accounted for a $7.4 million increase in interest earned on loans. The yield on the loan portfolio decreased to 5.81% for 2011 from 6.24% for 2010 period, which was primarily attributable to the lower interest rate environment in 2011 and the mix of average outstanding balances among the components of the loan portfolio.
 
Interest earned on the securities portfolio, on a tax-equivalent basis, decreased to $27.2 million for 2011 from $29.2 million in 2010. Average outstandings increased to $851.0 million (36.5% of average earning assets) for 2011 from $768.2 million (37.1% of average earning assets) in 2010. The average yield on investment securities decreased to 3.20% for 2011 from 3.80% in 2010. The change in both balances and yield reflect the impact of the Company’s asset/liability management strategy designed to shorten the average life of the portfolio to position it for rising interest rates in the future, as well as maintain liquidity to grow the loan portfolio. The short-term part of the strategy was implemented by the sale of available for sale securities, principally mortgage-backed securities with longer term average lives offset by the purchase of short-term corporate debt. The long-term part of the strategy was implemented through the purchase of obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises and obligations of state and political subdivisions with maturities up to 15 years.
 
Total interest expense decreased by $2.6 million for 2011 from $15.6 million for the 2010 period, primarily due to the impact of lower rates paid, coupled with lower balances for borrowings partially offset by the impact of higher interest-bearing deposit balances.
 
Interest expense on deposits decreased to $8.4 million for 2011 from $9.6 million for the 2010 period, due to a decrease in the cost of those funds partially offset by the impact of higher interest-bearing deposit balances. The average rate paid on interest-bearing deposits was 0.64%, which was 21 basis points lower than the prior year period. The decrease in average cost of deposits reflects the impact of deposit pricing strategies and the Company’s purchase of certificates of deposit from the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (“CDARS”) and various listing services which provided certificate of deposit balances at lower rates. Average interest-bearing deposits were $1,325.1 million for 2011 compared to $1,123.3 million for 2010, reflecting the impact of the Company’s business development activities, as well as funds received from CDARS and various listing services.
 
Interest expense on borrowings decreased to $4.5 million for 2011 from $6.0 million for the 2010 period, primarily due to lower cost of those funds, partially offset by the impact of the changes in mix. The average rate paid for borrowed funds was 1.96%, which was 26 basis points lower than the prior-year period. The decrease in the average cost of borrowings reflects the lower interest rate envi­ronment in 2011. During the 2011 first quarter, the bank restructured a portion of its Federal Home Loan Bank fixed rate advances by repaying $100 million of existing borrowings and replacing them with $100 million of lower cost, floating rate advances. This transaction resulted in $4.2 million in prepayment penalties that were deferred and will be recognized in interest expense as an adjustment to the cost of these borrowings in future periods. The existing borrowings were a combination of fixed rate and amortizing advances with an average cost of 2.58% and an
 
 
PAGE 36

 
 
average duration of 3.2 years. The new borrowings are all floating-rate advances with a current average cost of 1.58%, including the deferred adjustment, with an average duration of three months. The relevant accounting treatment for this transaction was provided by ASC 470-50. This transaction was executed as an earnings and interest rate risk strategy, resulting in lower FHLB advance costs and a reduction of average duration. Average borrowings decreased to $232.5 million for 2011 from $270.6 million in the prior-year period, reflecting lesser reliance by the Company on wholesale funding.
 
Provision for Loan Losses
Based on management’s continuing evaluation of the loan portfolio (discussed under “Asset Quality” beginning on page 41), the provision for loan losses for 2011 was $12.0 million, compared to $28.5 million for 2010. Factors affecting the lower provision for the year of 2011 included current economic conditions and a lower level of net charge-offs and lower nonaccrual loan balances.
 
The level of the allowance reflects changes in the size of the portfolio or in any of its components, as well as management’s continuing evaluation of industry concentrations, specific credit risks, loan loss experience, current loan portfolio qual­ity, present economic, and political and regulatory condi­tions. Portions of the allowance may be allocated for specific credits; however, the entire allowance is available for any credit that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. While management utilizes its best judgment and infor­mation available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including the performance of the Company’s loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward loan classifications.
 
During 2011, the allowance for loan losses increased $1.8 million from $18.2 million at December 31, 2010, principally due to increases in the allowance allocated to residential real estate mortgages ($1.0 million) and loans to nondepository institutions ($0.8 million). The increase in the allowance allocated to residential real estate mortgages was primarily due to higher levels of nonaccrual loans. The increase in the allowance allocated to loans to nondepository institutions was primarily due to a single borrower who provides financing to real estate projects that was downgraded during 2011 to substandard.
 
Noninterest Income
Noninterest income decreased to $40.9 million for 2011 from $43.8 million in the 2010 period. The decrease principally resulted from securities gains recognized in the 2011 period compared to securities gains recognized in the 2010 period. Also contributing to the decrease was lower mortgage banking and deposit service charge income partially offset by higher income related to accounts receivable management and factoring services. Securities gains declined and reflected a modification of the asset/liability management program commenced in 2009 that was designed to reduce the average life of the investment securities portfolio, which was replaced by the strategy that was described under Net Interest Income on page 36. The Company sold approximately $170.9 million of securities with a weighted average life of about 2.9 years. The proceeds were used to fund loan growth or were reinvested in obligations of state and political subdivisions and U.S. government agencies with maturities of approximately 18 years and 5 years, respectively, and in short-term corporate securities. The decrease in mortgage banking income was primarily due to lower volume of loans sold, as well as a charge taken in the fourth quarter for incurred and probable repurchase obligations. Deposit service charges were lower primarily due to higher balances maintained in customer accounts. Commissions and other fees earned from accounts receivable management and factoring services were higher primarily due to the impact of increased volumes at our factoring unit and billings by clients providing temporary staffing.
 
Noninterest Expenses
Noninterest expenses for 2011 increased $3.0 million when compared to 2010. The increase was primarily due to the impact of higher personnel and occupancy expenses reflecting the Company’s continued investment in the franchise. Additionally, in the fourth quarter, the Company recorded a charge related to the settlement of certain litigation and recognized an expense related to the write-down of certain assets to realizable value.
 
Provision for Income Taxes
The provision for income taxes for 2011 increased to $4.2 million, reflecting an effective tax rate of 19.3%, compared with $2.2 million for 2010, reflecting an effective tax rate of 23.5%. The higher provision was due to the higher level of taxable income, the impact of which was partially offset by the net benefit recognized, in the fourth quarter as the result of the completion of federal tax audits for the periods 2002 through 2009.
 
BALANCE SHEET ANALYSIS
 
Securities
At December 31, 2012, the Company’s portfolio of securities totaled $683.2 million, of which obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises amounted to $276.7 million which is approximately 40.5% of the total. The Company has the intent and ability to hold to maturity securities classified as held to maturity, at which
 
 
PAGE 37

 
 
time it will receive full value for these securities. These securities are carried at cost, adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts. The gross unrealized gains and losses on held to maturity securities were $16.9 million and $0.1 million, respectively. Securities classified as available for sale may be sold in the future, prior to maturity. These securities are carried at fair value. Net aggregate unrealized gains or losses on these securities are included, net of taxes, as a component of shareholders’ equity. Given the generally high credit quality of the portfolio, management expects to realize all of its investment upon market recovery or the maturity of such instruments and thus believes that any impairment in value is interest-rate-related and therefore temporary. Avail­able for sale securities included gross unrealized gains of $6.1 million and gross unrealized losses of $0.9 million. As of December 31, 2012, management does not have the intent to sell any of the securities classified as available for sale in the table on page 39 and management believes that it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell any such securities before a recovery of cost.
 
The following table sets forth the composition of the ­Com­pany’s investment securities by type, with related carrying values at the end of each of the three most recent fiscal years:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
 
U.S. Treasury securities
  $ 6,386       0.93 %   $       %   $       %
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                                               
Residential mortgage-backed securities
                                               
CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)
    2,051       0.30       3,942       0.58       7,504       0.95  
CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    23,157       3.39       28,213       4.16       47,422       6.01  
CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
    3,291       0.48       5,667       0.84       7,290       0.92  
Federal National Mortgage Association
    34,709       5.08       49,148       7.25       78,822       9.98  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    15,787       2.31       23,719       3.50       40,628       5.15  
Government National Mortgage Association
    3,471       0.51       4,230       0.62       5,052       0.64  
Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    82,466       12.07       114,919       16.95       186,718       23.65  
Agency notes
                                               
Federal National Mortgage Association
    96,628       14.14       105,482       15.56       115,133       14.59  
Federal Home Loan Bank
    82,490       12.07       45,094       6.65       24,932       3.16  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    15,079       2.21       35,374       5.22       92,479       11.72  
Federal Farm Credit Bank
                251       0.04       15,109       1.91  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    276,663       40.49       301,120       44.42       434,371       55.03  
Obligations of state and political subdivisions—New York bank qualified
    153,905       22.53       160,503       23.68       157,013       19.89  
Single issuer, trust preferred securities
    38,885       5.69       27,059       3.99       3,933       0.50  
Other preferred securities
    11,953       1.75                          
Corporate debt securities
    174,418       25.53       173,307       25.57       189,058       23.95  
Equity and other securities
    21,035       3.08       15,882       2.34       4,940       0.63  
Total marketable securities
  $ 683,245       100.00 %   $ 677,871       100.00 %   $ 789,315       100.00 %
 
The following table presents information regarding the average life and yields of certain available for sale (“AFS”) and held to maturity (“HTM”) securities:

   
Weighted Average Life (years)
 
Weighted Average Yield
December 31, 2012
 
AFS
 
HTM
 
AFS
 
HTM
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    2.0       3.2       1.14 %     4.46 %
Agency notes (with original call dates ranging between 3 and 36 months)
    0.5       4.5       0.89       1.19  
Corporate debt securities
    1.1             2.23        
Obligations of state and political subdivisions
    5.1       5.8       5.93 [1]     5.96 [1]
 
[1] Tax equivalent
 
 
PAGE 38

 
 
The following tables present information regarding securities available for sale and securities held to maturity at December 31, 2012, based on contractual maturity. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties. The average yield on obligations of state and political subdivisions securities is presented on a tax-equivalent basis.
 
Available for sale
 
Amortized Cost
   
Fair Value
   
Weighted Average Yield
 
U.S. Treasury securities
  $ 6,387     $ 6,386       0.16%  
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                       
Residential mortgage-backed securities
                       
CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    19,615       19,632       1.23  
CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
    3,293       3,291       1.16  
Federal National Mortgage Association
    1,860       1,978       3.18  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    20       19       5.34  
Government National Mortgage Association
    85       86       1.01  
Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    24,873       25,006       1.37  
Agency notes
                       
Federal National Mortgage Association
                       
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    650       651       0.63  
Federal Home Loan Bank
                       
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    250       251       1.00  
Due after 5 years but within 10 years
    250       250       0.63  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
                       
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    75       79       4.50  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    26,098       26,237       1.35  
Obligations of state and political institutions
                       
Due after 5 years but within 10 years
    3,355       3,632       5.74  
Due after 10 years
    13,144       14,291       5.98  
Total obligations of state and political institutions
    16,499       17,923       5.93  
Single-issuer trust preferred securities
                       
Due within 1 year
    7,724       7,673       0.47  
Due after 10 years
    30,151       31,212       7.60  
Total single-issuer trust preferred securities
    37,875       38,885       6.15  
Other preferred securities
                       
Due within 1 year
    11,910       11,849       1.49  
Due after 10 years
    102       104       6.00  
Total other preferred securities
    12,012       11,953       1.53  
Corporate debt securities
                       
Due within 6 months
    51,690       51,705       1.81  
Due after 6 months but within 1 year
    47,689       47,926       2.09  
Due after 1 year but within 2 years
    54,872       55,484       2.87  
Due after 2 years but within 5 years
    16,430       16,532       2.52  
Due after 5 years but within 10 years
    2,552       2,664       5.50  
Due after 10 years
    99       107       7.00  
Total corporate debt securities
    173,332       174,418       2.35  
Equity and other securities
    19,371       21,035       2.71  
Total available for sale
  $ 291,574     $ 296,837       2.90%  
 
 
PAGE 39

 
 
Held to maturity
 
Carrying Value
   
Fair Value
   
Weighted Average Yield
 
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                 
Residential mortgage-backed securities
                 
CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)
  $ 2,051     $ 2,139       4.09%  
CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    3,525       3,670       4.18  
Federal National Mortgage Association
    32,731       35,585       4.39  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    15,768       17,005       4.26  
Government National Mortgage Association
    3,385       3,944       6.49  
Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    57,460       62,343       4.46  
Agency notes
                       
Federal National Mortgage Association
                       
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    10,000       10,007       1.00  
Due after 10 years
    85,977       85,991       1.12  
Federal Home Loan Bank
                       
Due after 10 years
    81,989       82,015       1.07  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
                       
Due after 10 years
    15,000       15,021       2.33  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    250,426       255,377       1.94  
Obligations of state and political institutions
                       
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    155       167       5.12  
Due after 5 years but within 10 years
    9,267       10,232       5.71  
Due after 10 years
    126,560       137,442       5.98  
Total obligations of state and political institutions
    135,982       147,841       5.96  
Total held to maturity
  $ 386,408     $ 403,218       3.35%  

Loan Portfolio
A management objective is to maintain the quality of the loan portfolio. The Company seeks to achieve this objective by maintaining rigorous underwriting standards coupled with regular evaluation of the creditworthiness of and the designation of lending limits for each borrower. The portfolio strategies include seeking industry and loan size diversification in order to minimize credit exposure and originating loans in markets with which the Company is familiar.
 
The Company’s commercial and industrial loan and factored receivables portfolios represented approximately 44% of all loans as of December 31, 2012. Loans in this category are typically made to individuals and small and medium-sized businesses in amounts generally up to $20 million. Loans to nondepository financial institutions, which include the Company’s residential mortgage warehouse funding product and loans to finance companies, represented approximately 20% of all loans. The Company’s equipment financing portfolio, which consists of finance leases for various types of business equipment, represented approximately 9% of all loans. The Company’s real estate loan portfolios, which represented approximately 26% of all loans, are secured by mortgages on real property located principally in the states of New York, New Jersey, Connecticut, Virginia and North Carolina. Sources of repayment are from the borrower’s operating profits, cash flows and liquidation of pledged collateral. Based on underwriting standards, loans and leases may be secured in whole or in part by collateral such as liquid assets, accounts receivable, equipment, inventory and real property. The collateral securing any loan or lease may depend on the type of loan and may vary in value based on market conditions. Loans to borrowers located in the states of New York and New Jersey represented approximately 53% and 13%, respectively, of all loans. Loans to borrowers located in any other state did not exceed 10% of all loans.
 
 
PAGE 40

 
 
The following table sets forth the composition of the Company’s loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years; there were no foreign loans outstanding at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years.
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
   
Balances
   
% of
Total
 
Domestic
                                                           
Commercial and industrial
  $ 627,785       35.45 %   $ 624,124       41.15 %   $ 618,223       45.92 %   $ 550,285       44.76 %   $ 531,471       44.00 %
Loans to nondepository institutions
    348,809       19.69       246,587       16.26       112,882       8.38       35,591       2.90       N/A        
Factored receivables
    151,593       8.56       171,831       11.33       161,789       12.02       139,927       11.38       89,145       7.38  
Equipment financing receivables
    162,094       9.15       150,782       9.94       144,235       10.72       195,056       15.87       255,743       21.17  
Real estate
                                                                               
Residential mortgage—portfolio
    151,609       8.56       170,153       11.22       127,695       9.49       124,681       10.14       142,135       11.76  
Residential mortgage—held for sale
    121,237       6.85       43,372       2.86       32,049       2.38       33,889       2.76       23,403       1.94  
Commercial mortgage
    182,735       10.32       85,825       5.66       96,991       7.20       92,614       7.53       96,883       8.02  
Construction and land development
    13,277       0.75       13,621       0.90       25,624       1.90       24,277       1.97       25,249       2.09  
Loans to individuals
    11,851       0.67       10,376       0.68       11,370       0.84       12,984       1.06       18,959       1.57  
Loans to depository institutions
                10             15,425       1.15       20,000       1.63       25,000       2.07  
Total
  $ 1,770,990       100.00 %   $ 1,516,681       100.00 %   $ 1,346,283       100.00 %   $ 1,229,304       100.00 %   $ 1,207,988       100.00 %
 
Based on contractual maturity date, the following table sets forth information regarding the Company’s commercial and industrial, factored receivables and construction and land development loans, as of December 31, 2012:
 
   
Due One
Year
or Less
   
Due One
to Five
Years
   
Due
After Five
Years
   
Total
Gross Loans
 
Commercial and industrial
  $ 533,347     $ 92,920     $ 3,102     $ 629,369  
Factored receivables
    151,830                   151,830  
Real estate—construction and land development
    12,818       459             13,277  
 
All commercial and industrial loans due after one year have predetermined interest rates.
 
All real estate—construction and land development loans due after one year have floating or adjustable interest rates.
 
Asset Quality
Intrinsic to the lending process is the possibility of loss. In times of economic slowdown, the risk of loss inherent in the Company’s portfolio of loans may increase. While management endeavors to minimize this risk, it recognizes that loan losses will occur and that the amount of these losses will fluctuate depending on the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio, which in turn depend on current and future economic conditions, the financial condition of borrowers, the realization of collateral, and the credit management process.
 
Nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2012 decreased $436 thousand from December 31, 2011. This primarily reflected decreases of $2.4 million and $31 thousand in commercial real estate loans and equipment financing receivables, respectively, partially offset by an increase of $1.7 million in commercial and industrial loans and $334 thousand in residential real estate mortgage loans. Net loan charge-offs in 2012 were $2.5 million lower than those in 2011 (primarily reflecting decreases in net charge-offs of $4.7 million for equipment financing receivables and $491 thousand for residential real estate mortgage loans, partially offset by increases of $1.9 million and $605 thousand in commercial and industrial loan charge-offs and commercial real estate mortgage loan charge-offs). A worsening of existing economic conditions would likely result in levels of charge-offs and non­accrual loans that would be higher than those in the historical levels.
 
 
PAGE 41

 
 
The following table sets forth the amount of domestic nonaccrual and past due loans of the Company at the end of each of the five most recent fiscal years; there were no foreign loans accounted for on a nonaccrual basis. At December 31, 2012, approximately $7.6 million of equipment financing receivables and residential real estate loans were troubled debt restructurings. See Note 5 beginning on page 76 for additional discussion. Loans contractually past due 90 days or more as to principal or interest and still accruing are loans that are both well-secured or guaranteed by financially responsible third parties and are in the process of collection.
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Gross loans
  $ 1,787,835     $ 1,534,779     $ 1,365,296     $ 1,254,946     $ 1,245,263  
Nonaccrual loans
                                       
Commercial and industrial
  $ 2,495     $ 834     $ 1,014     $ 4,231     $ 816  
Factored receivables
                             
Equipment financing receivables
    339       370       892       11,960       3,387  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    2,325       1,991       1,614       1,786       3,078  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    745       3,124       3,124              
Real estate—construction and land development
                             
Loans to individuals
    18       39                   63  
Total nonaccrual loans
    5,922       6,358       6,644       17,977       7,344  
Past due 90 days or more (other than the above)
    245       165       314       1,194       821  
Restructured loans (other than the above)
    6,812       5,851       5,829       5,176       70  
Total
  $ 12,979     $ 12,374     $ 12,787     $ 24,347     $ 8,235  
Interest income that would have been earned on nonaccrual loans outstanding
  $ 819     $ 780     $ 902     $ 1,463     $ 731  
Applicable interest income actually realized on nonaccrual loans outstanding
  $ 61     $ 200     $ 204     $ 743     $ 321  
Nonaccrual and past due loans as a percentage of total gross loans
    0.34 %     0.43 %     0.51 %     1.53 %     0.66 %
 
Interest income that would have been earned in 2012 on restructured loans amounted to $765 thousand. Interest income actually realized in 2012 on restructured loans was $412 thousand.
 
At December 31, 2012, commercial and industrial nonaccruals represented 0.40% of commercial and industrial loans. There were five loans made to borrowers located in four states with balances ranging between approximately $43.6 thousand and $1.76 million.
 
At December 31, 2012, equipment financing nonaccruals represented 0.19% of equipment financing receivables. The lessees of the equipment are located in five states. There were seven leases ranging between approximately $7.8 thousand and $77.6 thousand. The value of the underlying collateral related to lease financing nonaccruals varies depending on the type and condition of equipment. While most leases are written on a recourse basis, with personal guarantees of the principals, the current value of the collateral is often less than the lease financing balance. Collection efforts include repossession and/or sale of leased equipment, payment discussions with the lessee, the principals and/or guarantors, and obtaining judgments against the lessee, the principals and/or guarantors. The balance is charged off at the earlier of the date when the lease is past due 120 days or the date when it is determined that collection efforts are no longer productive. Factors considered in determining whether collection efforts are no longer productive include any amounts currently being collected, the status of discussions or negotiations with the lessee, the principal and/or guarantors, the cost of continuing efforts to collect, the status of any foreclosure or other legal actions, the value of the collateral, and any other pertinent factors.
 
At December 31, 2012, residential real estate nonaccruals represented 1.53% of residential real estate loans held in portfolio. There were 13 loans ranging between approximately $4.0 thousand and $658.0 thousand secured by properties located in five states.
 
 
PAGE 42

 
 
At December 31, 2012, commercial real estate nonaccruals represented 0.41% of commercial real estate loans. There was one loan for $745.3 thousand secured by property located in one state.
 
At December 31, 2012, other real estate owned consisted of eight properties valued between $6.0 thousand and $554.6 thousand located in four states.
 
The allowance for loan losses is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, which represents management’s best estimate of probable losses that have been incurred within the existing portfolio of loans. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. The Company’s allowance for loan losses methodology includes allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 310, Receivables and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450, Contingencies. Accordingly, the methodology is based on historical loss experience by type of credit and internal risk grade, specific homogenous pools and specific loss allocations, with adjustments for current events and conditions. The Company’s process for the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses is designed to account for credit deterioration as it occurs. The provision for loan losses reflects loan quality trends, including the levels of and trends related to nonaccrual loans, past due loans, potential problem loans, classified and criticized loans and net charge-offs or recoveries, among other factors. The provision for loan losses also reflects the totality of actions taken on all loans for a particular period. In other words, the amount of the provision reflects not only the necessary increases in the allowance for loan losses related to newly identified criticized loans, but it also reflects actions taken related to other loans including, among other things, any necessary increases or decreases in required allowances for specific loans or loan pools. See Note 5—Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses in the accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report for further details regarding the methodology for estimating the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses.
 
At December 31, 2012, the ratio of the allowance to loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, was 1.35% and the allowance was $22.3 million. Loans 90 days past due and still accruing amounted to $245 thousand. At such date, the Company’s nonaccrual loans amounted to $5.9 million; $3.9 million of such loans were judged to be impaired within the scope of FASB Codification Topic 310, Receivables, and had a valuation allowance totaling $0.6 million, which is included within the overall allowance for loan losses. Based on the foregoing, as well as management’s judgment as to the current risks inherent in loans held in port­folio, the Company’s allowance for loan losses was deemed adequate to absorb all probable losses on specifically known and other credit risks associated with the portfolio as of December 31, 2012. Net losses within loans held in portfolio are not statistically predictable and changes in conditions in the next twelve months could result in future provisions for loan losses varying from the provision taken in 2012. We did not have any potential problem loans, which are loans that are currently performing under present loan repayment terms but where known information about possible credit problems of borrowers causes management to have serious doubts as to the ability of the borrowers to continue to comply with the present repayment terms.
 
 
PAGE 43

 
 
The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the Company’s loan loss experience for each of the five most recent fiscal years:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
Average loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, during year
  $ 1,534,478     $ 1,351,407     $ 1,227,049     $ 1,154,041     $ 1,120,362  
Allowance for loan losses:
                                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 20,029     $ 18,238     $ 19,872     $ 16,010     $ 15,085  
Charge-offs:
                                       
Commercial and industrial
    4,993       2,909       7,212       4,945       2,610  
Factored receivables
    387       358       665       514       581  
Equipment financing receivables
    2,602       8,266       22,509       19,115       3,886  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    618       1,266       351       312       58  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    671             129              
Real estate—construction and land development
                             
Loans to individuals
    194       30       231              
Total charge-offs
    9,465       12,829       31,097       24,886       7,135  
Recoveries:
                                       
Commercial and industrial
    267       146       312       1,042       297  
Factored receivables
    102       79       239       63       26  
Equipment financing receivables
    1,282       2,255       902       345       294  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    8       165             102       61  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    66                          
Real estate—construction and land development
                             
Loans to individuals
    15             48             69  
Total recoveries
    1,740       2,645       1,501       1,552       747  
Subtract:
                                       
Net charge-offs
    7,725       10,184       29,596       23,334       6,388  
Provision for loan losses
    10,250       12,000       28,500       27,900       8,325  
Less loss on transfers to other real estate owned
    207       25       538       704       1,012  
Balance at end of year
  $ 22,347     $ 20,029     $ 18,238     $ 19,872     $ 16,010  
Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts, during year
    0.50 %     0.75 %     2.41 %     2.02 %     0.57 %
 
 
PAGE 44

 
 
The following table presents the Company’s allocation of the allowance for loan losses. This allocation is based on estimates by management and may vary from year to year based on management’s evaluation of the risk characteristics of the loan portfolio. The amount allocated to a particular loan category of the Company’s loans held in portfolio may not necessarily be indicative of actual future charge-offs in that loan category.
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
 
   
Amount
   
% of Loans
in each category to total loans
held in portfolio
   
Amount
   
% of Loans
in each category to total loans
held in portfolio
   
Amount
   
% of Loans
in each category to total loans
held in portfolio
   
Amount
   
% of Loans
in each category to total loans
held in portfolio
   
Amount
   
% of Loans
in each category to total loans
held in portfolio
 
Domestic
                                                           
Commercial and industrial
  $ 8,662       38.05 %   $ 7,647       42.36 %   $ 7,454       47.04 %   $ 6,082       46.03 %   $ 5,530       44.87 %
Loans to nondepository institutions
    1,726       21.14       1,369       16.74       564       8.59             2.98              
Factored receivables
    1,447       9.19       1,450       11.66       1,424       12.31       971       11.70       933       7.52  
Equipment financing receivables
    3,763       9.83       3,515       10.24       3,423       10.97       10,249       16.32       6,130       21.59  
Real estate—residential mortgage (portfolio)
    3,764       9.19       3,490       11.55       2,497       9.72       1,646       10.43       2,355       12.00  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    2,504       11.08       2,151       5.83       2,275       7.38       560       7.75       674       8.18  
Real estate—construction and land development
    156       0.80       165       0.92       310       1.95       149       2.03       175       2.13  
Loans to individuals
    163       0.72       104       0.70       119       0.87       80       1.09       88       1.60  
Loans to depository institutions
                            46       1.17             1.67       88       2.11  
Unallocated
    162             138             126             135             37        
Total
  $ 22,347       100.00 %   $ 20,029       100.00 %   $ 18,238       100.00 %   $ 19,872       100.00 %   $ 16,010       100.00 %
 
During 2012, the allowance for loan losses increased $2.3 million from $20.0 million at December 31, 2011 principally due to increases in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans ($1.0 million), loans to nondepository financial institutions ($0.4 million), equipment financing receivables ($0.2 million), residential real estate mortgage loans ($0.3 million) and commercial real estate mortgage loans ($0.4 million). The increase in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans was primarily due to higher levels of nonaccrual loans. The increase in the allowance allocated to loans to nondepository financial institutions, equipment financing receivables and commercial real estate mortgage loans was primarily due to higher loan balances in these categories. The increase in the allowance allocated to residential real estate mortgage loans was primarily due to higher levels of nonaccrual and restructured loans in this category.
 
During 2011, the allowance for loan losses increased $1.8 million from $18.2 million at December 31, 2010 principally due to increases in the allowance allocated to real estate residential mortgages ($1.0 million) and loans to nondepository financial institutions ($0.8 million). The increase in the allowance allocated to residential real estate mortgages was primarily due to higher levels of nonaccrual loans. The increase in the allowance allocated to loans to nondepository financial institutions was primarily due to higher loan balances in this category.
 
During 2010, the allowance for loan losses decreased $1.6 million from $19.9 million at December 31, 2009 primarily due to a reduction in the allowance allocated to lease financing receivables ($6.8 million) partially offset by increases in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans ($1.4 million), factored receivables ($0.5 million), real estate residential mortgage loans ($0.9 million), and real estate commercial mortgage loans ($1.7 million) and real estate construction and land development loans ($0.2 million). The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables decreased primarily as a result of the lower level of lease financing receivables nonaccrual balances. The increase of the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans was primarily the result of the unsteady economic recovery. The allowance to factored receivables increased based on the continued weakening in the consumer sectors. The increase in the allowance allocated to real estate residential mortgage loans was primarily due to the persistent decline in residential real estate values. As a result of the disruption in the commercial real estate markets, the allowance allocated to real estate commercial mortgage loans and to real estate construction and land development loans was increased.
 
During 2009, the allowance for loan losses increased because of increases in the allowance allocated to lease financing receivables and in the allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans, partially offset by a reduction in the allowance allocated to real estate-residential mortgage loans. The allowance allocated to lease financing receivables increased primarily as a
 
 
PAGE 45

 
 
result of increased losses experienced in that category in 2009 compared to 2008 partially offset by a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. The impact of the increase in nonaccrual lease financing receivables at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 was mitigated by decreasing levels of nonaccruals in that category in the third and fourth quarters of 2009 compared to the second quarter of 2009. The allowance allocated to commercial and industrial loans increased due to increased losses experienced in that category in 2009 compared to 2008 and higher nonaccrual levels in that category at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 partially offset by a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. The allowance allocated to real estate-residential mortgage loans decreased primarily due to lower nonaccrual loan balances at December 31, 2009 compared to December 31, 2008 coupled with a decrease in the specific valuation allowance for impaired loans. During the fourth quarter of 2009 the level of the allowance for loan losses benefited from a recovery of $0.9 million on a loan charged off in a prior period.
 
Deposits
A significant source of funds are customer deposits, consisting of demand (noninterest-bearing), NOW, savings, money market and time deposits (principally certificates of deposit).
 
The following table provides certain information with respect to the Company’s deposits at the end of each of the three most recent fiscal years; there were no foreign deposits in any of the periods presented:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Balances
   
% of Total
   
Balances
   
% of Total
   
Balances
   
% of Total
 
Domestic
                                   
Demand
  $ 924,351       40.75 %   $ 765,800       38.50 %   $ 570,290       32.63 %
NOW
    199,934       8.82       177,495       8.93       200,521       11.47  
Savings
    24,886       1.10       18,566       0.93       18,931       1.08  
Money Market
    476,872       21.02       369,362       18.57       342,755       19.61  
Time deposits less than $100 thousand
    94,411       4.16       116,049       5.83       126,834       7.26  
Time deposits greater than $100 thousand
    547,630       24.15       541,799       27.24       488,433       27.95  
Total deposits
  $ 2,268,084       100.00 %   $ 1,989,071       100.00 %   $ 1,747,764       100.00 %
 
The Company participates in the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (“CDARS”). CDARS deposits totaled approximately $100.9 million at December 31, 2012 and averaged approximately $120.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. CDARS deposits totaled approximately $164.5 million at December 31, 2011 and averaged approximately $224.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2011. CDARS deposits totaled approximately $180.7 million at December 31, 2010 and averaged approximately $184.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
Scheduled maturities of time deposits at December 31, 2012 were as follows:
 
2013
  $ 542,552  
2014 and later
    99,489  
    $ 642,041  
 
Scheduled maturities of time deposits in amounts of $100,000 or more at December 31, 2012 were as follows:
 
Due within 3 months or less
  $ 164,281  
Due after 3 months and within 6 months
    187,858  
Due after 6 months and within 12 months
    122,212  
Due after 12 months
    73,279  
    $ 547,630  
 
Fluctuations of balances in total or among categories at any date can occur based on the Company’s mix of assets and liabilities, as well as on customers’ balance sheet strategies. Historically, however, average balances for deposits have been relatively stable. Information regarding these average balances for the three most recent fiscal years is presented on page 47.
 
 
PAGE 46

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED AVERAGE BALANCE SHEETS AND
ANALYSIS OF NET INTEREST EARNINGS[1]
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
   
Average Rate
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
   
Average Rate
   
Average Balance
   
Interest
   
Average Rate
 
ASSETS
                                                     
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
  $ 58,836     $ 136       0.23 %   $ 93,561     $ 227       0.24 %   $ 31,960     $ 75       0.23 %
Investment securities
                                                                       
Available for sale—taxable
    344,634       8,453       2.45       371,377       9,379       2.53       394,635       10,863       2.75  
Held to maturity—taxable
    255,878       5,622       2.20       322,312       8,078       2.51       252,915       10,879       4.30  
Tax-exempt[2]
    154,887       9,682       6.25       157,308       9,784       6.22       120,634       7,422       6.15  
Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock
    8,018       413       5.14       8,770       374       4.27       8,617       448       5.20  
Loans, net of unearned discounts[3]
    1,583,836       83,982       5.56       1,379,361       75,251       5.81       1,262,403       73,166       6.24  
TOTAL INTEREST-EARNING ASSETS
    2,406,089       108,288       4.64 %     2,332,689       103,093       4.58 %     2,071,164       102,853       5.19 %
Cash and due from banks
    38,180                       39,734                       36,810                  
Allowance for loan losses
    (22,444 )                     (19,951 )                     (21,668 )                
Goodwill
    22,901                       22,901                       22,901                  
Other
    132,089                       132,811                       135,362                  
TOTAL ASSETS
  $ 2,576,815                     $ 2,508,184                     $ 2,244,569                  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
                                                                       
Interest-bearing deposits
                                                                       
Domestic
                                                                       
Savings
  $ 21,796       4       0.02 %   $ 18,474       8       0.04 %   $ 18,631       11       0.06 %
NOW
    218,021       258       0.12       210,443       372       0.18       209,197       472       0.23  
Money market
    413,475       2,324       0.56       367,090       2,475       0.67       336,233       2,805       0.83  
Time
    645,745       4,151       0.64       729,053       5,583       0.77       558,886       6,297       1.13  
Foreign
                                                                       
Time
                                        317       3       1.09  
Total interest-bearing deposits
    1,299,037       6,737       0.52       1,325,060       8,438       0.64       1,123,264       9,588       0.85  
Borrowings
                                                                       
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
    39,318       141       0.36       42,911       186       0.43       47,674       229       0.48  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers
    2,637       31       1.18       5,186       66       1.27       5,618       44       0.79  
Federal funds purchased
    10,093       22       0.22       10,926       14       0.13       33,192       74       0.22  
Short-term borrowings—FRB
                                        3,699       9       0.25  
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    14,826       43       0.29       18,120       45       0.25       22,024       63       0.29  
Advances—FHLB
    113,293       1,913       1.69       129,558       2,144       1.66       132,577       3,482       2.63  
Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures
    25,774       2,094       8.38       25,774       2,094       8.38       25,774       2,094       8.38  
Total borrowings
    205,941       4,244       2.07       232,475       4,549       1.96       270,558       5,995       2.22  
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    1,504,978       10,981       0.73 %     1,557,535       12,987       0.83 %     1,393,822       15,583       1.12 %
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
    782,771                     596,608                     489,184                
Total including noninterest-bearing demand deposits
    2,287,749       10,981       0.50 %     2,154,143       12,987       0.61 %     1,883,006       15,583       0.83 %
Other liabilities
    61,447                       129,221                       148,410                  
Total Liabilities
    2,349,196                       2,283,364                       2,031,416                  
Shareholders’ equity
    227,619                       224,820                       213,153                  
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
  $ 2,576,815                     $ 2,508,184                     $ 2,244,569                  
Net interest income/spread
            97,307       3.91 %             90,106       3.75 %             87,270       4.07 %
Net yield on interest-earning assets
                    4.17 %                     4.01 %                     4.40 %
Less: Tax-equivalent adjustment
            3,393                       3,428                       2,601          
Net interest income
          $ 93,914                     $ 86,678                     $ 84,669          

[1] The average balances of assets, liabilities and shareholders’ equity are computed on the basis of daily averages. Average rates are presented on a tax-equivalent basis. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior period amounts to conform to current presentation.
[2] Interest on tax-exempt securities included herein is presented on a tax-equivalent basis.
[3] Includes loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio; all loans are domestic. Nonaccrual loans are included in amounts outstanding and income has been included to the extent earned.
 
 
PAGE 47

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED RATE/VOLUME ANALYSIS[1]
 
Increase (Decrease) from Years Ended,
 
December 31, 2011 to
December 31, 2012
   
December 31, 2010 to
December 31, 2011
 
   
Volume
   
Rate
   
Total[2]
   
Volume
   
Rate
   
Total[2]
 
   
(in thousands)
 
INTEREST INCOME
                                   
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
  $ (82 )   $ (9 )   $ (91 )   $ 149     $ 3     $ 152  
Investment securities
                                               
Available for sale—taxable
    (635 )     (291 )     (926 )     (630 )     (854 )     (1,484 )
Held to maturity—taxable
    (1,527 )     (929 )     (2,456 )     2,484       (5,285 )     (2,801 )
Tax-exempt
    (144 )     42       (102 )     2,277       85       2,362  
Total
    (2,306 )     (1,178 )     (3,484 )     4,131       (6,054 )     (1,923 )
Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock
    (33 )     72       39       8       (82 )     (74 )
Loans, net of unearned discounts[3]
    12,173       (3,442 )     8,731       7,421       (5,336 )     2,085  
TOTAL INTEREST INCOME
  $ 9,752     $ (4,557 )   $ 5,195     $ 11,709     $ (11,469 )   $ 240  
INTEREST EXPENSE
                                               
Interest-bearing deposits
                                               
Domestic
                                               
Savings
  $ 1     $ (5 )   $ (4 )   $     $ (3 )   $ (3 )
NOW
    15       (129 )     (114 )     3       (103 )     (100 )
Money market
    290       (441 )     (151 )     241       (571 )     (330 )
Time
    (568 )     (864 )     (1,432 )     1,618       (2,332 )     (714 )
Foreign
                                               
Time
                      (3 )           (3 )
Total interest-bearing deposits
    (262 )     (1,439 )     (1,701 )     1,859       (3,009 )     (1,150 )
Borrowings
                                               
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
    (14 )     (31 )     (45 )     (21 )     (22 )     (43 )
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers
    (30 )     (5 )     (35 )     (3 )     25       22  
Federal funds purchased
    (1 )     9       8       (37 )     (23 )     (60 )
Short-term borrowings—FRB
                      (9 )           (9 )
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    (9 )     7       (2 )     (2 )     (16 )     (18 )
Advances—FHLB
    (269 )     38       (231 )     (77 )     (1,261 )     (1,338 )
Total borrowings
    (323 )     18       (305 )     (149 )     (1,297 )     (1,446 )
TOTAL INTEREST EXPENSE
  $ (585 )   $ (1,421 )   $ (2,006 )   $ 1,710     $ (4,306 )   $ (2,596 )
NET INTEREST INCOME
  $ 10,337     $ (3,136 )   $ 7,201     $ 9,999     $ (7,163 )   $ 2,836  

[1] Amounts are presented on a tax-equivalent basis.
[2] The change in interest income and interest expense due to a combination of both volume and rate have been allocated to the change due to volume and the change due to rate in proportion to the relationship of the change due solely to each. The change in interest expense for foreign time deposits and short-term borrowings—FRB has been allocated entirely to the volume variance. The effect of the extra day in 2012 has been allocated entirely to the volume variance.
[3] Includes loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio; all loans are domestic. Nonaccrual loans have been included in the amounts outstanding and income has been included to the extent earned.
 
 
PAGE 48

 
 
ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT
 
The Company’s primary earnings source is its net interest income; therefore, the Company devotes significant time and has invested in resources to assist in the management of interest rate risk and asset quality. The Company’s net interest income is affected by changes in market interest rates, and by the level and composition of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. The Company’s objectives in its asset/liability management are to utilize its capital effectively, to provide adequate liquidity and to enhance net interest income, without taking undue risks or subjecting the Company unduly to interest rate fluctuations.
 
The Company takes a coordinated approach to the management of its liquidity, capital and interest rate risk. This risk management process is governed by policies and limits established by senior management, which are reviewed and approved by the Asset/Liability Committee. This committee, which is comprised of members of senior management, meets to review, among other things, economic conditions, interest rates, yield curves, cash flow projections, expected customer actions, liquidity levels, capital ratios and repricing characteristics of assets, liabilities and financial instruments.
 
Market Risk
Market risk is the risk of loss in a financial instrument arising from adverse changes in market indices such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates and equity prices. The Company’s principal market risk exposure is interest rate risk, with no material impact on earnings from changes in foreign exchange rates or equity prices.
 
Interest rate risk is the exposure to changes in market interest rates. Interest rate sensitivity is the relationship between market interest rates and net interest income due to the repricing characteristics of assets and liabilities. The Company monitors the interest rate sensitivity of its balance sheet positions by examining its near-term sensitivity and its longer-term gap position. In its management of interest rate risk, the Company utilizes several financial and statistical tools including traditional gap analysis and sophisticated income simulation models.
 
A traditional gap analysis is prepared based on the maturity and repricing characteristics of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities for selected time bands. The mismatch between repricings or maturities within a time band is commonly referred to as the “gap” for that period. A positive gap (asset sensitive) where interest rate sensitive assets exceed interest rate sensitive liabilities generally will result in the net interest margin increasing in a rising rate environment and decreasing in a falling rate environment. A negative gap (liability sensitive) will generally have the opposite result on the net interest margin. However, the traditional gap analysis does not assess the relative sensitivity of assets and liabilities to changes in interest rates and other factors that could have an impact on interest rate sensitivity or net interest income. The Company utilizes the gap analysis to complement its income simulations modeling, primarily focusing on the longer-term structure of the balance sheet.
 
The Company’s balance sheet structure is primarily short-term in nature with a substantial portion of assets and liabilities repricing or maturing within one year. The Company’s gap analysis at December 31, 2012, presented on page 55, indicates that net interest income would increase during periods of rising interest rates and decrease during periods of falling interest rates, but, as mentioned above, gap analysis may not be an accurate predictor of net interest income.
 
 
PAGE 49

 
 
As part of its interest rate risk strategy, the Company may use financial instrument derivatives to hedge the interest rate sensitivity of assets. The Company has written policy guidelines, approved by the Board of Directors, governing the use of financial instruments, including approved counterparties, risk limits and appropriate internal control procedures. The credit risk of derivatives arises principally from the potential for a counterparty to fail to meet its obligation to settle a contract on a timely basis.
 
As of December 31, 2012, the Company was not a party to any financial instrument derivative agreement.
 
The Company utilizes income simulation models to complement its traditional gap analysis. While the Asset/Liability Committee routinely monitors simulated net interest income sensitivity over a rolling two-year horizon, it also utilizes additional tools to monitor potential longer-term interest rate risk. The income simulation models measure the Company’s net interest income volatility or sensitivity to interest rate changes utilizing statistical techniques that allow the Company to consider various factors, which impact net interest income. These factors include actual maturities, estimated cash flows, repricing characteristics, deposit growth/retention and, most importantly, the relative sensitivity of the Company’s assets and liabilities to changes in market interest rates. This relative sensitivity is important to consider as the Company’s core deposit base has not been subject to the same degree of interest rate sensitivity as its assets. The core deposit costs are internally managed and tend to exhibit less sensitivity to changes in interest rates than the Company’s adjustable rate assets whose yields are based on external indices and generally change in concert with market interest rates.
 
The Company’s interest rate sensitivity is determined by identifying the probable impact of changes in market interest rates on the yields on the Company’s assets and the rates that would be paid on its liabilities. This modeling technique involves a degree of estimation based on certain assumptions that management believes to be reasonable. Utilizing this process, management projects the impact of changes in interest rates on net interest margin. The Company has established certain policy limits for the potential volatility of its net interest margin assuming certain levels of changes in market interest rates with the objective of maintaining a stable net interest margin under various probable rate scenarios. Man­agement generally has maintained a risk position well within the policy limits. As of December 31, 2012, the model indicated the impact of a 100 and 200 basis point parallel and pro rata rise in rates over 12 months would approximate a 2.7% ($3.2 million) and a 5.6% ($6.7 million) increase in net interest income, respectively, while the impact of a 25 basis point decline in rates over the same period would approximate a 1.1% ($1.4 million) decline from an unchanged rate environment. The likelihood of a decrease in interest rates beyond 25 basis points as of December 31, 2012 was considered to be remote given then-current interest rate levels. As of December 31, 2011, the model indicated the impact of a 100 and 200 basis point parallel and pro rata rise in rates over 12 months would approximate a 2.4% ($2.8 million) and a 5.0% ($6.0 million) increase in net interest income, respectively, while the impact of a 25 basis point decline in rates over the same period would approximate a 0.8% ($0.9 million) decline from an unchanged rate environment. The likelihood of a decrease in interest rates beyond 25 basis points as of December 31, 2011 was considered to be remote given then-current interest rate levels.
 
 
PAGE 50

 
 
The preceding sensitivity analysis does not represent a Company forecast and should not be relied upon as being indicative of expected operating results. These hypothetical estimates are based upon numerous assumptions including: the nature and timing of interest rate levels including yield curve shape, prepayments on loans and securities, deposit decay rates, pricing decisions on loans and deposits, reinvestment/replacement of asset and liability cash flows, and others. While assumptions are developed based upon current economic and local market conditions, the Company cannot provide any assurances as to the predictive nature of these assumptions, including how customer preferences or competitor influences might change.
 
Also, as market conditions vary from those assumed in the sensitivity analysis, actual results will also differ due to: prepayment/refinancing levels likely deviating from those assumed, the varying impact of interest rate change caps or floors on adjustable rate assets, the potential effect of changing debt service levels on customers with adjustable rate loans, depositor early withdrawals and product preference changes, and other variables. Furthermore, the sensitivity analysis does not reflect actions that the Asset/Liability Committee might take in responding to or anticipating changes in interest rates.
 
The shape of the yield curve can cause downward pressure on net interest income. In general, if and to the extent that the yield curve is flatter (i.e., the differences between interest rates for different maturities are relatively smaller) than previously anticipated, then the yield on the Company’s interest-earning assets and its cash flows will tend to be lower. Management believes that a relatively flat yield curve could continue to affect adversely the Company’s results in 2013.
 
Liquidity Risk
Liquidity is the ability to meet cash needs arising from changes in various categories of assets and liabilities. Liquidity is constantly monitored and managed at both the parent company and the bank levels. Liquid assets consist of cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits in banks and Federal funds sold and securities available for sale. Primary funding sources include core deposits, capital markets funds and other money market sources. Core deposits include domestic noninterest-bearing and interest-bearing retail deposits, which historically have been relatively stable. The parent company and the bank believe that they have significant unused borrowing capacity. Contingency plans exist, which we believe could be implemented on a timely basis to mitigate the impact of any dramatic change in market conditions.
 
The parent company depends for its cash requirements on funds maintained or generated by its subsidiaries, principally the bank. Such sources have been adequate to meet the parent company’s cash requirements throughout its history.
 
Various legal restrictions limit the extent to which the bank can supply funds to the parent company and its nonbank subsidiaries. All national banks are limited in the payment of dividends without the approval of the Comptroller of the Currency to an amount not to exceed the net profits (as defined) for the year-to-date combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years (see Note 15 on page 94).
 
 
PAGE 51

 
 
In December 2008, under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, we issued to the U.S. Treasury 42,000 of the parent company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Shares, Series A, liquidation preference of $1,000 per share (“Series A Preferred Shares”) and a 10-year warrant to purchase up to 516,817 of the parent company’s common shares. On April 27, 2011, the parent company paid $42.4 million to the U.S. Treasury for the repurchase in full of the Series A Preferred Shares. As a result of this action, the Series A Preferred Shares were redeemed in full, eliminating an annual dividend of $2.1 million. In this connection, in determining net income available to common shareholders, the Company recognized in the second quarter of 2011 a $1.2 million charge for accelerated accretion, which represents the difference between the carrying value and the liquidation value for the repurchased Series A Preferred Shares. On May 18, 2011, the parent company paid approximately $0.95 million to the U.S. Treasury to repurchase the 10-year warrant in full. The parent company’s repurchase of the warrant concluded its participation in the TARP Capital Purchase Program.
 
At December 31, 2012, the parent company’s short-term debt, consisting principally of commercial paper used to finance ongoing current business activities, was approximately $16.3 million. The parent company had cash, interest-bearing deposits with banks and other current assets aggregating $33.2 million. The parent company also has back-up credit lines with banks of $14.0 million. Since 1979, the parent company has had no need to use available back-up lines of credit.
 
OFF-BALANCE-SHEET ARRANGEMENTS, COMMITMENTS, GUARANTEES, AND CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS
 
The following table summarizes the Company’s contractual obligations and other commitments to make future payments as of December 31, 2012. Payments for borrowings do not include interest. Payments related to leases are based on actual payments specified in the underlying contracts. Loan commitments and standby letters of credit are presented at contractual amounts; however, since many of these commitments are expected to expire unused or only partially used, the total amounts of these commitments do not necessarily reflect future cash requirements.
 
   
Payments Due by Period
 
Contractual
Obligations
 
Total
   
Less than 1 Year
   
1–2
Years
   
2–3
Years
   
3–4
Years
   
4–5
Years
   
After 5
Years
 
Long-Term Debt[1]
  $ 127,039     $ 995     $ 270     $     $ 100,000     $     $ 25,774  
Operating Leases
    41,027       4,513       4,910       4,683       3,956       3,691       19,274  
Total Contractual Cash Obligations
  $ 168,066     $ 5,508     $ 5,180     $ 4,683     $ 103,956     $ 3,691     $ 45,048  
 
[1] Based on contractual maturity date.
 
   
Amount of Commitment Expiration Per Period
 
Other Commercial
Commitments
 
Total
   
Less than 1 Year
   
1–2
Years
   
2–3
Years
   
3–4
Years
   
4–5
Years
   
After 5
Years
 
Residential Loans
  $ 140,967     $ 140,967     $     $     $     $     $  
Commercial Loans
    38,197       20,998       4,997       12,202                    
Total Loan Commitments
    179,164       161,965       4,997       12,202                    
Standby Letters of Credit
    28,735       21,906       6,829                          
Other Commercial Commitments
    40,044       38,922                               1,122  
Total Commercial Commitments
  $ 247,943     $ 222,793     $ 11,826     $ 12,202     $     $     $ 1,122  
 
 
PAGE 52

 
 
Financial Instruments with Off-Balance-Sheet Risk
In the normal course of business the Company enters into various transactions which, in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, are not included in its consolidated balance sheets. The Company enters into these transactions to meet the financing needs of its customers. These transactions include commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit, which involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk and interest rate risk in excess of the amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets. The Company minimizes its exposure to loss under these commitments by subjecting them to credit approval and monitoring procedures. The Company also holds certain assets which are not included in its consolidated balance sheets including assets held in fiduciary or custodial capacity on behalf of its trust customers and certain collateral funds resulting from acting as an agent in its securities lending program.
 
Commitments to Extend Credit
The Company enters into contractual commitments to extend credit, normally with fixed expiration dates or termination clauses, at specified rates and for specific purposes. Substantially all of the Company’s commitments to extend credit are contingent upon customers maintaining specific credit standards at the time of loan funding. Commitments to extend credit outstanding at December 31, 2012 are included in the table above.
 
Standby Letters of Credit
Standby letters of credit are written conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. In the event the customer does not perform in accordance with the terms of the agreement with the third party, the Company would be required to fund the commitment. The maximum potential amount of future payments the Company could be required to make is represented by the contractual amount of the commitment. If the commitment is funded, the Company would be entitled to seek recovery from the customer. The Company’s policies generally require that standby letter of credit arrangements contain security and debt covenants similar to those contained in loan agreements. Standby letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2012 are included in the table above. The Company holds primarily cash or cash equivalents as collateral supporting these commitments.
 
The Company is obligated under certain unfunded benefit plans to make payments to individuals upon their retirement. While the Company is not aware of any near term plans for retirement of executive officers at this time, actuarial expected benefit payments are disclosed in Note 17 beginning on page 96 based on eligibility.
 
While past performance is not a guarantee of future performance, management believes that the parent company’s funding sources (including div­idends from all its subsidiaries) and the bank’s funding sources will be adequate to meet their liquidity requirements in the future.
 
The liquidity position of the parent company and the bank is regularly monitored and adjustments are made to the balance between sources and uses of funds as deemed appropriate. Management is not aware of any events that are reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s liquidity, capital resources or operations. In addition, management is not aware of any regulatory recommendations regarding liquidity, which if implemented, would have a material adverse effect on the Company.
 
 
PAGE 53

 
 
CAPITAL
 
The Company and the bank are subject to risk-based capital regulations which quantitatively measure capital against risk-weighted assets, including certain off-balance-sheet items. These regulations define the elements of the Tier 1 and Tier 2 components of total capital and currently establish minimum ratios of 4% for Tier 1 capital and 8% for Total capital for capital adequacy purposes. Sup­plementing these regulations is a leverage requirement. This requirement establishes a minimum leverage ratio (at least 3% or 4%, depending upon an institution’s regulatory status), which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by adjusted quarterly average assets (after deducting goodwill). Information regarding the Company’s and the bank’s risk-based capital at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011 is presented in Note 21 beginning on page 108. In addition, the bank is subject to the provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”) which imposes a number of mandatory supervisory measures. Among other matters, FDICIA established five cap­ital categories ranging from “well capitalized” to “critically undercapitalized.” Such classifications are used by regulatory agencies to determine a bank’s deposit insurance premium, approval of applications authorizing institutions to increase their asset size or otherwise expand business activities or acquire other institutions. Under FDICIA, a “well capitalized” bank must maintain minimum leverage, Tier 1 and Total capital ratios of 5%, 6% and 10%, respectively. The Federal Reserve Board applies comparable tests for holding companies such as the Company. At December 31, 2012, the Company and the bank exceeded the requirements for “well capitalized” institutions under the tests pursuant to FDICIA and of the Federal Reserve Board.
 
The bank regulatory agencies have encouraged banking organizations, including healthy, well-run banking organizations, to operate with capital ratios substantially in excess of the stated ratios required to maintain “well capitalized” status. This has resulted from, among other things, current economic conditions, the global financial crisis and the likelihood, as described below, of increased formal capital requirements for banking organizations. In light of the foregoing, the Company and the bank expect that they will maintain capital ratios substantially in excess of these ratios.
 
The elements currently comprising Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital, the minimum Tier 1 capital and Total capital ratios and the minimum leverage ratio may in the future be subject to change, as discussed in greater detail under the caption “SUPERVISION AND REGULATION” beginning on page 3.
 
IMPACT OF INFLATION AND CHANGING PRICES
 
The Company’s financial statements included herein have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which require the Company to measure financial position and operating results primarily in terms of historical dollars. Changes in the relative value of money due to inflation or recession are generally not considered. The primary effect of inflation on the operations of the Company is reflected in increased operating costs. In management’s opinion, changes in interest rates affect the financial condition of a financial institution to a far greater degree than do changes in the inflation rate. While interest rates are greatly influenced by changes in the inflation rate, they do not necessarily change at the same rate or in the same magnitude as the inflation rate. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors that are beyond the control of the Company, including changes in the expected rate of inflation, the influence of general and local economic conditions and the monetary and fiscal policies of the United States government, its agencies and various other governmental regulatory authorities, among other things, as further discussed under the caption “RISKS RELATED TO THE COMPANY’S BUSINESS” beginning on page 15 and under the caption “ASSET/LIABILITY MANAGEMENT” beginning on page 49.
 
RECENTLY ISSUED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS
 
See “Adoption of New Accounting Standards” and “Newly Issued Not Yet Effective Standards” in Note 1 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements for information regarding recently issued accounting pronouncements and their expected impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
 
PAGE 54

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED INTEREST RATE SENSITIVITY
 
To mitigate the vulnerability of earnings to changes in interest rates, the Company manages the repricing characteristics of assets and liabilities in an attempt to control net interest rate sensitivity. Management attempts to confine significant rate sensitivity gaps predominantly to repricing intervals of a year or less, so that adjustments can be made quickly. Assets and liabilities with prede­termined repricing dates are classified based on the earliest repricing period. Based on the interest rate sensitivity analysis shown below, the Company’s net interest income would increase during periods of rising interest rates and decrease during periods of falling interest rates.
 
   
Repricing Date
 
December 31, 2012
 
3 Months
or Less
   
More than
3 Months
to 1 Year
   
More than
1 Year to
5 Years
   
More than
5 Years to
10 Years
   
Over
10 Years
   
Nonrate Sensitive
   
Total
 
ASSETS
                                         
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
  $ 112,886     $     $     $     $     $     $ 112,886  
Investment securities
    139,376       228,795       76,576       145,777       92,721             683,245  
Commercial and industrial loans
    461,941       71,406       92,920       3,102             (1,584 )     627,785  
Equipment financing receivables
    243       8,041       165,871       2,929             (14,990 )     162,094  
Factored receivables
    151,830                               (237 )     151,593  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    138,342       30,007       51,871       22,554       30,072             272,846  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    9,396       26,516       121,632       23,620       1,571             182,735  
Real estate—construction loans
    12,818             459                         13,277  
Loans to individuals
    8,673       1,228       1,540       410                   11,851  
Loans to nondepository institutions
    288,807       44,426       15,562             48       (34 )     348,809  
Noninterest-earning assets and allowance for loan losses
                                  183,721       183,721  
Total Assets
    1,324,312       410,419       526,431       198,392       124,412       166,876       2,750,842  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
                                                       
Interest-bearing deposits
                                                       
Savings
                24,886                         24,886  
NOW
                199,934                         199,934  
Money market
    391,034             85,838                         476,872  
Time—domestic
    184,714       357,838       99,425       64                   642,041  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
    32,950                                     32,950  
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    15,345                                     15,345  
Advances—FHLB
    100,371       623       271                         101,265  
Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures
                            25,774             25,774  
Noninterest-bearing liabilities and shareholders’ equity
                                  1,231,775       1,231,775  
Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
    724,414       358,461       410,354       64       25,774       1,231,775       2,750,842  
Net Interest Rate Sensitivity Gap
  $ 599,898     $ 51,958     $ 116,077     $ 198,328     $ 98,638     $ (1,064,899 )   $  
Cumulative Gap at December 31, 2012
  $ 599,898     $ 651,856     $ 767,933     $ 966,261     $ 1,064,899     $     $  
Cumulative Gap at December 31, 2011
  $ 425,764     $ 399,400     $ 478,582     $ 602,894     $ 901,522     $     $  
Cumulative Gap at December 31, 2010
  $ 377,384     $ 308,139     $ 289,256     $ 468,057     $ 786,799     $     $  

 
PAGE 55

 
 
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
 
The Company’s consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2012 and 2011 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012, and the statements of condition of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2012 and 2011, notes thereto and the Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firms thereon appear on pages 57–113.
 
 
PAGE 56

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
   
(dollars in thousands,
except per share data)
 
ASSETS
           
Cash and due from banks
  $ 38,944     $ 31,046  
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    112,886       126,448  
Securities available for sale (at estimated fair value; pledged: $174,240 in 2012 and $146,429 in 2011)
    296,837       270,014  
Securities held to maturity (pledged: $136,109 in 2012 and $206,282 in 2011) (estimated fair value: $403,218 in 2012 and $425,775 in 2011)
    386,408       407,857  
Total investment securities
    683,245       677,871  
Loans held for sale
    121,237       43,372  
Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts
    1,649,753       1,473,309  
Less allowance for loan losses
    22,347       20,029  
Loans, net
    1,627,406       1,453,280  
Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock, at cost
    7,472       8,486  
Customers’ liability under acceptances
          4  
Goodwill
    22,901       22,901  
Premises and equipment, net
    22,578       23,625  
Other real estate
    1,452       1,929  
Accrued interest receivable
    6,853       6,838  
Cash surrender value of life insurance policies
    54,556       53,446  
Other assets
    51,312       44,051  
Total assets
  $ 2,750,842     $ 2,493,297  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
  $ 924,351     $ 765,800  
Savings, NOW and money market deposits
    701,692       565,423  
Time deposits
    642,041       657,848  
Total deposits
    2,268,084       1,989,071  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
    32,950       47,313  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers
          5,000  
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    15,345       13,485  
Advances—FHLB
    101,265       122,733  
Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures
    25,774       25,774  
Total borrowings
    175,334       214,305  
Acceptances outstanding
          4  
Accrued interest payable
    649       1,064  
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
    78,685       68,032  
Total liabilities
    2,522,752       2,272,476  
Commitments and contingent liabilities
               
Shareholders’ Equity
               
Common shares, $1 par value per share. Authorized 50,000,000 shares; issued 35,263,768 and 35,225,110 shares, respectively
    35,264       35,225  
Capital surplus
    271,565       270,869  
Retained earnings
    24,407       15,523  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (16,491 )     (14,216 )
Common shares in treasury at cost, 4,307,972 and 4,300,278 shares, respectively
    (86,655 )     (86,580 )
Total shareholders’ equity
    228,090       220,821  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 2,750,842     $ 2,493,297  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
PAGE 57

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(dollars in thousands, except per share data)
 
INTEREST INCOME
                 
Loans
  $ 83,982     $ 75,251     $ 73,166  
Investment securities
                       
Available for sale—taxable
    8,453       9,379       10,863  
Held to maturity—taxable
    5,622       8,078       10,879  
Tax exempt
    6,293       6,359       4,824  
Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank stock
    409       371       445  
Deposits with other banks
    136       227       75  
Total interest income
    104,895       99,665       100,252  
INTEREST EXPENSE
                       
Deposits
                       
Savings, NOW and Money Market
    2,586       2,855       3,288  
Time
    4,151       5,583       6,300  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
    141       186       229  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers
    31       66       44  
Federal funds purchased
    22       14       74  
Short-term borrowings—FRB
                9  
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    43       45       63  
Advances—FHLB
    1,913       2,144       3,482  
Long-term borrowings—subordinated debentures
    2,094       2,094       2,094  
Total interest expense
    10,981       12,987       15,583  
Net interest income
    93,914       86,678       84,669  
Provision for loan losses
    10,250       12,000       28,500  
Net interest income after provision for loan losses
    83,664       74,678       56,169  
NONINTEREST INCOME
                       
Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees
    19,131       22,371       20,510  
Service charges on deposit accounts
    5,301       5,093       5,506  
Trade finance income
    1,922       2,222       2,264  
Other customer related service charges and fees
    1,001       943       777  
Mortgage banking income
    10,275       6,315       8,164  
Trust fees
          53       329  
Income from life insurance policies
    1,315       1,140       1,138  
Securities gains
    1,813       2,491       3,928  
Loss on other real estate owned
    (61 )           (64 )
Other income
    76       270       1,275  
Total noninterest income
    40,773       40,898       43,827  
NONINTEREST EXPENSES
                       
Salaries
    45,530       43,748       41,586  
Employee benefits
    14,902       13,898       12,220  
Total personnel expense
    60,432       57,646       53,806  
Occupancy and equipment expenses, net
    13,689       13,248       12,296  
Advertising and marketing
    2,815       2,792       3,381  
Professional fees
    4,841       5,219       5,464  
Communications
    2,029       1,756       1,691  
Deposit insurance
    2,229       2,747       3,809  
Other expenses
    9,849       10,376       10,365  
Total noninterest expenses
    95,884       93,784       90,812  
Income before income taxes
    28,553       21,792       9,184  
Provision for income taxes
    8,537       4,196       2,158  
Net income
    20,016       17,596       7,026  
Dividends on preferred shares and accretion
          2,074       2,589  
Net income available to common shareholders
  $ 20,016     $ 15,522     $ 4,437  
Average number of common shares outstanding
                       
Basic
    30,828,293       30,038,047       24,492,279  
Diluted
    30,828,293       30,038,047       24,495,044  
Net income available to common shareholders, per average common share
                       
Basic
  $ 0.65     $ 0.51     $ 0.18  
Diluted
    0.65       0.51       0.18  
Dividends per common share
    0.36       0.36       0.36  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
PAGE 58

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF
COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Net income
  $ 20,016     $ 17,596     $ 7,026  
Other comprehensive loss, net of tax:
                       
Unrealized gains on securities:
                       
Unrealized holding gains on available for sale securities arising during the year
    4,878       244       2,101  
Reclassification adjustment for gains included in net income
    (1,006 )     (1,382 )     (2,145 )
Pension liability adjustment—net actuarial losses
    (8,438 )     (2,006 )     (1,940 )
Reclassification adjustment for amortization of:
                       
Prior service cost
    21       35       36  
Net actuarial losses
    2,270       1,780       1,460  
Other comprehensive loss
    (2,275 )     (1,329 )     (488 )
Comprehensive income
  $ 17,741     $ 16,267     $ 6,538  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
PAGE 59

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF
CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
PREFERRED SHARES
                 
Balance at beginning of year
  $     $ 40,602     $ 40,113  
Redemption
          (42,000 )      
Discount accretion
          1,398       489  
Balance at end of year
  $     $     $ 40,602  
COMMON SHARES
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 35,225     $ 31,139     $ 22,227  
Common shares issued for acquisition
    39              
Common shares issued—public offering
          4,025       8,625  
Common shares issued under stock incentive plan
          61       287  
Balance at end of year
  $ 35,264     $ 35,225     $ 31,139  
WARRANT TO PURCHASE COMMON SHARES
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $     $ 2,615     $ 2,615  
Repurchase
          (2,615 )      
Balance at end of year
  $     $     $ 2,615  
CAPITAL SURPLUS
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 270,869     $ 236,437     $ 178,734  
Common shares issued for acquisition
    336              
Common shares issued—public offering
          32,429       56,256  
Restricted shares issued
          (61 )      
Common shares issued under stock incentive plan and related tax benefits
                1,190  
Stock option and restricted stock compensation expense
    360       394       257  
Repurchase of warrants
          1,670        
Balance at end of year
  $ 271,565     $ 270,869     $ 236,437  
RETAINED EARNINGS
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 15,523     $ 11,392     $ 15,828  
Net income
    20,016       17,596       7,026  
Cash dividends paid—common shares
    (11,132 )     (11,122 )     (8,873 )
Cash dividends paid—preferred shares
          (945 )     (2,100 )
Discount accretion on Series A preferred shares
          (1,398 )     (489 )
Balance at end of year
  $ 24,407     $ 15,523     $ 11,392  
ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ (14,216 )   $ (12,887 )   $ (12,399 )
Other comprehensive loss, net of tax
    (2,275 )     (1,329 )     (488 )
Balance at end of year
  $ (16,491 )   $ (14,216 )   $ (12,887 )
TREASURY SHARES
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ (86,580 )   $ (86,556 )   $ (85,168 )
Surrender of shares issued under stock incentive plan
    (75 )     (24 )     (1,388 )
Balance at end of year
  $ (86,655 )   $ (86,580 )   $ (86,556 )
TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
                       
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 220,821     $ 222,742     $ 161,950  
Net changes during the year
    7,269       (1,921 )     60,792  
Balance at end of year
  $ 228,090     $ 220,821     $ 222,742  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
PAGE 60

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
                 
Net income
  $ 20,016     $ 17,596     $ 7,026  
Adjustments to reconcile income from continuing operations to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities:
                       
Provision for loan losses
    10,250       12,000       28,500  
Depreciation and amortization of premises and equipment
    3,680       3,256       2,436  
Securities gains
    (1,813 )     (2,491 )     (3,928 )
Income from life insurance policies, net
    (786 )     (625 )     (1,135 )
Deferred income tax (benefit) provision
    (2,808 )     2,079       (2,430 )
Proceeds from sale of loans
    554,286       370,681       493,147  
Gains on sales of loans, net
    (10,322 )     (6,335 )     (8,176 )
Originations of loans held for sale
    (624,294 )     (376,674 )     (484,395 )
Amortization of premiums on investment securities
    8,104       8,914       6,993  
Accretion of discounts on investment securities
    (711 )     (467 )     (559 )
(Increase) Decrease in accrued interest receivable
    (15 )     1,442       721  
(Decrease) Increase in accrued interest payable
    (415 )     (250 )     23  
(Decrease) Increase in due to factored clients
          (91,543 )     9,142  
(Decrease) Increase in accrued expenses and other liabilities
    (414 )     623       8,742  
(Increase) Decrease in other assets
    (2,268 )     3,110       (8,139 )
Loss on OREO
    61             64  
Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities
    (47,449 )     (58,684 )     48,032  
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
                       
Purchase of premises and equipment
    (2,611 )     (10,972 )     (8,687 )
Net decrease (increase) in interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    13,562       (85,945 )     (3,545 )
Net increase in loans held in portfolio
    (202,467 )     (181,334 )     (126,361 )
Net decrease (increase) in short-term factored receivables
    20,238       11,007       (21,862 )
Proceeds from sale of other real estate
    677       193       1,259  
Proceeds from calls/sales of securities—available for sale
    181,767       286,276       486,191  
Proceeds from calls of securities—held to maturity
    266,162       322,500       142,380  
Proceeds from sales of securities—held to maturity
          2,141        
Proceeds from prepayments, redemptions or maturities of securities—held to maturity
    36,794       47,567       64,327  
Proceeds from redemptions of Federal Home Loan Bank Stock
    1,250       1,089       977  
Purchases of securities—held to maturity
    (281,442 )     (379,731 )     (209,964 )
Proceeds from prepayments, redemptions or maturities—available for sale
    563,095       347,745       210,749  
Purchases of securities—available for sale
    (770,352 )     (503,633 )     (744,344 )
Purchases of Federal Home Loan Bank stock
    (236 )     (210 )     (1,860 )
Net cash used in investing activities
    (173,563 )     (143,307 )     (210,740 )
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
                       
Net increase in noninterest-bearing demand deposits
    158,551       195,510       23,953  
Net increase (decrease) in savings, NOW, money market deposits
    136,269       3,216       (29,808 )
Net (decrease) increase in time deposits
    (15,807 )     42,581       172,952  
Net decrease in Federal funds purchased
          (15,000 )     (26,000 )
Net (decrease) increase in securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    (19,363 )     24,297       6,968  
Net increase (decrease) in commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    1,860       (4,393 )     (51,928 )
(Decrease) Increase in long-term borrowings
    (21,468 )     (21,440 )     14,173  
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
                403  
Proceeds from issuance of common shares
          36,454       64,881  
Cash dividends paid on common shares
    (11,132 )     (11,122 )     (8,873 )
Cash dividends paid on preferred shares
          (945 )     (2,100 )
Net redemption of preferred shares and common share warrants
          (42,945 )      
Net cash provided by financing activities
    228,910       206,213       164,621  
Net increase in cash and due from banks
    7,898       4,222       1,913  
Cash and due from banks—beginning of year
    31,046       26,824       24,911  
Cash and due from banks—end of year
  $ 38,944     $ 31,046     $ 26,824  
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:
                       
Interest paid
  $ 11,396     $ 13,237     $ 15,559  
Income taxes paid
    7,527       5,748       4,011  
Loans held for sale transferred to portfolio
    2,465       1,004       1,264  
Loans in portfolio transferred to other real estate
    318       2,048       533  
Due to brokers on purchases of securities held to maturity
          943       4,998  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
PAGE 61

 
 
Sterling National Bank
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CONDITION
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
   
(dollars in thousands,
except per share data)
 
ASSETS
           
Cash and due from banks
  $ 38,940     $ 31,034  
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    112,886       126,448  
Securities available for sale (at estimated fair value; pledged: $174,240 in 2012 and $146,429 in 2011)
    285,274       261,442  
Securities held to maturity (pledged: $136,109 in 2012 and $206,282 in 2011) (estimated fair value: $403,218 in 2012 and $425,775 in 2011)
    386,408       407,857  
Total investment securities
    671,682       669,299  
Loans held for sale
    121,237       43,372  
                 
Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts
    1,638,980       1,463,182  
Less allowance for loan losses
    22,347       20,029  
Loans, net
    1,616,633       1,443,153  
Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan bank stock, at cost
    7,472       8,486  
Customers’ liability under acceptances
          4  
Goodwill
    1,742       1,742  
Premises and equipment, net
    22,578       23,622  
Other real estate
    1,452       1,929  
Accrued interest receivable
    6,853       6,642  
Cash surrender value of life insurance policies
    49,797       48,838  
Other assets
    55,369       53,136  
Total assets
  $ 2,706,641     $ 2,457,705  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER’S EQUITY
               
Noninterest-bearing demand deposits
  $ 924,375     $ 786,673  
Savings, NOW and money market deposits
    708,141       567,021  
Time deposits
    642,041       657,848  
Total deposits
    2,274,557       2,011,542  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
    32,950       47,313  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers
          5,000  
Advances—FHLB
    101,265       122,733  
Acceptances outstanding
          4  
Accrued interest payable
    646       1,062  
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
    70,030       64,807  
Total liabilities
    2,479,448       2,252,461  
Commitments and contingent liabilities
               
Shareholder’s Equity
               
Common shares, $50 par value per share; Authorized and issued, 358,526 shares
    17,926       17,926  
Capital surplus
    51,638       51,263  
Undivided profits
    170,740       146,888  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
    (13,111 )     (10,833 )
Total shareholder’s equity
    227,193       205,244  
Total liabilities and shareholder’s equity
  $ 2,706,641     $ 2,457,705  
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
 
PAGE 62

 
 
Sterling Bancorp
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
NOTE 1.
SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Sterling Bancorp is a financial holding company, pursuant to an election made under the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999. Throughout the notes, the term the “Company” refers to Sterling Bancorp and its consolidated subsidiaries and the term the “bank” refers to Sterling National Bank and its consolidated subsidiaries, while the term the “parent company” refers to Sterling Bancorp but not its subsidiaries. The Company provides a full range of banking and financial products and services, including business and consumer lending, asset-based financing, residential mortgage warehouse funding, factoring/accounts receivable management services, equipment financing, commercial and residential mortgage lending and brokerage, deposit services and trade financing. The Company has operations principally in New York and conducts business throughout the United States.
 
The Company’s financial statements are prepared in accord­ance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“U.S. GAAP”), which, effective for all interim and annual periods ending after September 15, 2009, principally consist of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“Codification”). FASB Codification Topic 105: Generally Accepted Accounting Principles establishes the FASB Codification as the source of authoritative accounting principles recognized by FASB to be applied by nongovernmental entities in the preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. Rules and interpretive releases of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), under authority of federal securities laws, are also sources of authoritative guidance for SEC registrants. All guidance contained in the FASB Codification carries an equal level of authority. All non-grandfathered, non-SEC accounting literature not included in the FASB Codification is superseded and deemed non-authoritative.
 
The following summarizes the significant accounting policies of the Company with specific references to the FASB Codification.
 
(a) Basis of Presentation
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the parent company and its subsidiaries, principally the bank, after elimination of intercompany transactions.
 
Generally, U.S. GAAP requires that all entities in which a company has a controlling financial interest be consolidated. The Company determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether it holds ownership of a majority voting interest. However, certain entities may not have voting interests or decision-making abilities because the controlling financial interest is achieved through other arrangements. These variable interest entities (“VIEs”) may still require consolidation even though equity investors do not have the typical characteristics of a controlling financial interest or do not have sufficient equity at risk for the legal entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support. A controlling financial interest in a VIE is present when an enterprise has the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the entity’s financial performance and an obligation to absorb a majority of the entity’s expected losses or receive a majority of the entity’s expected return. The enterprise with a controlling financial interest, known as the primary beneficiary, consolidates the VIE. The parent company’s wholly-owned subsidiary, Sterling Bancorp Trust I, is a VIE for which the Company is not the primary beneficiary. Accordingly, the accounts of this entity are not included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.
 
(b) General Accounting Policies
The preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP requires management to make assumptions and estimates, which impact the amounts reported in those statements and are, by their nature, subject to change in the future as additional information becomes available or as circumstances vary. Actual results could differ from management’s current estimates, as a result of changing conditions and future events. The current economic environment has increased the degree of uncertainty inherent in these significant estimates. Several accounting estimates are particularly critical and are susceptible to significant near-term change, including the allowance for loan losses and asset impairment judgments, such as other-than-temporary declines in the value of securities and the accounting for income taxes. The judgments used by management in applying these critical accounting policies may be affected by a further and prolonged deterioration or lack of significant improvement in the economic environment, which may result in changes to future financial results. For example, subsequent evaluations of the loan portfolio, in light of the factors then prevailing, may result in significant changes in the allowance for loan losses in future periods, and the inability to collect outstanding principal may result in increased loan losses.
 
The Company evaluates subsequent events through the date that the financial statements are issued.
 
 
PAGE 63

 
 
Certain reclassifications have been made to the prior years’ consolidated financial statements to conform to the current presentation. Throughout the notes, dollar amounts presented in tables are in thousands, except per share data.
 
(c) Adoption of New Accounting Standards
Accounting Standards Update ("ASU") No. 2011-03, “Transfers and Servicing (Topic 860)—Reconsideration of Effective Control for Repurchase Agreements.” ASU 2011-03 is intended to improve financial reporting of repurchase agreements and other agreements that both entitle and obligate a transferor to repurchase or redeem financial assets before their maturity. ASU 2011-03 removes from the assessment of effective control (i) the criterion requiring the transferor to have the ability to repurchase or redeem the financial assets on substantially the agreed terms, even in the event of default by the transferee and (ii) the collateral maintenance guidance related to that criterion. ASU 2011-03 was  effective for the Company on January 1, 2012 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
ASU No. 2011-04, “Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820)—Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurements and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs.” ASU 2011-04 amends Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures,” to converge the fair value measurement guidance in U.S. generally accepted accounting principles and International Financial Reporting Standards. ASU 2011-04 clarifies the application of existing fair value measurement requirements, changes certain principles in Topic 820 and requires additional fair value disclosures. ASU 2011-04 was effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011, and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
ASU No. 2011-05, “Comprehensive Income (Topic 220)—Presentation of Comprehensive Income.” ASU 2011-05 amends Topic 220, “Comprehensive Income,” to require that all nonowner changes in stockholders’ equity be presented in either a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. Additionally, ASU 2011-05 requires entities to present, on the face of the financial statements, reclassification adjustments for items that are reclassified from other comprehensive income to net income in the statement or statements where the components of other comprehensive income are presented. The option to present components of other comprehensive income as part of the statement of changes in stockholders’ equity was eliminated. ASU 2011-05 was effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011, and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
ASU No. 2011-12 “Comprehensive Income (Topic 220)—Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05.” ASU 2011-12 defers changes in ASU No. 2011-05 that relate to the presentation of reclassification adjustments to allow the FASB time to redeliberate whether to require presentation of such adjustments on the face of the financial statements to show the effects of reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income on the components of net income and other comprehensive income. ASU 2011-12 allows entities to continue to report reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income consistent with the presentation requirements in effect before ASU No. 2011-05. All other requirements in ASU No. 2011-05 are not affected by ASU No. 2011-12. ASU 2011-12 was effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2011 and did not have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
d) Newly Issued Not Yet Effective Standards
ASU No. 2011-11, “Balance Sheet (Topic 210)—Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities.” ASU 2011-11 amends Topic 210, “Balance Sheet”, to require an entity to disclose both gross and net information about financial instruments, such as sales and repurchase agreements and reverse sale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowing/lending arrangements, and derivative instruments that are eligible for offset in the statement of financial position and/or subject to master netting arrangement or similar agreement. ASU 2011-11 is effective for annual and interim periods beginning on January 1, 2013, and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
ASU No. 2012-02, “Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (Topic 350)—Testing Indefinite-Lived Intangible Assets for Impair­ment.” ASU 2012-02 gives entities the option to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to a determination that it is more likely than not that an indefinite-lived intangible asset is impaired. If after assessing the totality of events or circumstances, an entity determines it is more likely than not that an indefinite-lived intangible asset is impaired, then the entity must perform the quantitative impairment test. If, under the quantitative impairment test, the carrying amount of the intangible asset exceeds its fair value, an entity should recognize an impairment loss in the amount of that excess.  Permitting an entity to assess qualitative factors when testing indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment results in guidance that is similar to the goodwill impairment testing
 
 
PAGE 64

 
 
guidance in ASU 2011-08. ASU 2012-02 is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2013 (early adoption permitted) and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
ASU No. 2012-06, “Business Combinations (Topic 805)—Subsequent Accounting for an Indemnification Asset Recognized at the Acquisition Date as a Result of a Government-Assisted Acquisition of a Financial Institution (a consensus of the FASB Emerging Issues Task Force).” ASU 2012-06 clarifies the applicable guidance for subsequently measuring an indemnification asset recognized as a result of a government-assisted acquisition of a financial institution and, subsequently, a change in the cash flows expected to be collected on the indemnification asset occurs (as a result of a change in cash flows expected to be collected on the assets subject to indemnification), the reporting entity should subsequently account for the change in the measurement of the indemnification asset on the same basis as the change in the assets subject to indemnification. Any amortization of changes in value should be limited to the contractual term of the indemnification agreement (that is, the lesser of the term of the indemnification agreement and the remaining life or the indemnified assets). ASU 2012-06 is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2013 (early adoption permitted) and is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s financial statements.
 
(e) Investment Securities
Securities are designated at the time of acquisition as available for sale or held to maturity. Securities that the Company will hold for indefinite periods of time and that might be sold in the future as part of efforts to manage interest rate risk or in response to changes in interest rates, changes in prepayment risk, changes in market conditions or changes in economic factors are classified as available for sale and carried at estimated fair values. Net aggregate unrealized gains or losses are reported, net of taxes, as a component of shareholders’ equity through other comprehensive income. Securities that the Company has the positive intent and ability to hold to maturity are designated as held to maturity and are carried at amortized cost, adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts over the period to maturity. Interest income includes the amortization of purchase premiums and accretion of purchase discounts. Gains and losses realized on sales of securities are determined on the specific identification method and are reported in noninterest income.
 
Securities pledged as collateral are disclosed parenthetically in the Consolidated Balance Sheets if the secured party has the right by contract or custom to sell or repledge the collateral. Securities are pledged by the Company to secure trust and public deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, advances from the FHLB and for other purposes required or permitted by law.
 
A periodic review is conducted by management to determine if the decline in the fair value of any security appears to be other-than-temporary. Factors considered in determining whether the decline is other-than-temporary include, but are not limited to: the length of time and the extent to which fair value has been below cost; the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer; and the Company’s intent to sell. If the decline is deemed to be other-than-temporary, and the Company does not have the intent to sell and will not likely be required to sell, the security is written down to a new cost basis and the resulting credit component of the loss is reported in noninterest income and the remainder of the loss is recorded in shareholders’ equity. If the Company intends to sell or will be required to sell, the full amount of the other-than-temporary impairment is recorded in noninterest income.
 
(f) Loans
Loans (including factored accounts receivable), other than those held for sale, are reported at their principal amount outstanding, net of unearned discounts and unamortized nonrefundable fees and direct costs associated with their origination or acquisition. Interest earned on loans is credited to income based on loan principal amounts outstanding at appropriate interest rates. Origination and other nonrefundable fees net of direct costs and discounts on loans (excluding factored accounts receivable) are credited to income over the terms of the loans using a method that results in an approximately constant effective yield. Nonrefundable fees on the purchase of accounts receivable are credited to “Accounts receivable management/factoring commissions and other fees” at the time of purchase, which, based on our analysis, does not produce results that are materially different from the results under the amortization method specified in FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables.
 
Mortgage loans held for sale, including deferred fees and costs, are reported at the lower of cost or fair value as determined by outstanding commitments from investors or current investor yield requirements calculated on the aggregate loan basis and are included under the caption “Loans held for sale” in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recognized in a valuation allowance by a charge to income. Mortgage loans, including servicing rights, are sold without recourse. Gains or losses resulting from sales of mortgage loans, net of unamortized deferred fees and costs, are recognized when
 
 
PAGE 65

 
 
the proceeds are received from investors and are included under the caption “Mortgage banking income” in the Consolidated Statements of Income. In connection with its mortgage banking activities, the Company has commitments to fund loans held for sale and commitments to sell loans, which are considered derivative instruments under FASB Codification Topic 815: Derivatives and Hedging. The fair values of these free-standing derivative instruments were immaterial at December 31, 2012 and 2011.
 
A loan is impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due according to the original contractual terms of the loan agreement. Loans for which the borrower  has been given a concession through a modification of terms and for which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties are considered troubled debt restructurings and classified as impaired. Under the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, individually identified impaired loans are ­measured based on the present value of payments expected to be received, using the historical effective loan rate as the ­discount rate. Alternatively, measurement may also be based on observable market prices; or, for loans that are solely dependent on the collateral for repayment, measurement may be based on the fair value of the collateral. If the recorded investment in the impaired loan exceeds fair value, a valuation allowance is required as a component of the allowance for loan losses. Interest payments on impaired loans are typically applied to principal unless collectibility of the principal amount is reasonably assured, in which case interest is recognized on a cash basis. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.
 
Nonaccrual loans are those on which the accrual of interest has ceased. Loans, including loans that are individually identified as being impaired under FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, are generally placed on nonaccrual status immediately if, in the opinion of management, principal or interest is not likely to be paid in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement, or when principal or interest is past due 90 days or more and collateral, if any, is insufficient to cover principal and interest. Interest accrued but not collected at the date a loan is placed on nonaccrual status is reversed against interest income. Interest income is recognized on nonaccrual loans only to the extent received in cash. How­ever, where there is doubt regarding the ultimate collectibility of the loan principal, cash receipts, whether designated as principal or interest, are thereafter applied to reduce the carrying value of the loan. Loans are restored to accrual status only when interest and principal payments are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.
 
(g) Allowance for Loan Losses
The allowance for loan losses is a reserve established through a provision for loan losses charged to expense, which represents management’s best estimate of losses that have been incurred within the existing portfolio of loans. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. The allowance for loan losses includes allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450: Contingencies. Further information regarding the Company’s policies and methodology used to estimate the allowance for loan losses is presented in Note 5—Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses.
 
(h) Federal Reserve and Federal Home Loan Bank Stock
The bank is required to maintain a minimum level of investment in Federal Home Loan Bank of New York (“FHLB”) stock based on specific percentages of its outstanding mortgages, total assets or FHLB advances. FHLB and Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”) stocks are restricted because they may only be sold to another member institution of the FHLB or FRB at their par values. Due to restrictive terms, and the lack of a readily determinable market value, FHLB and FRB stocks are shown separately in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, carried at cost and evaluated for ultimate recovery of par value.
 
(i) Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
Goodwill, representing the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of net assets of businesses acquired, reflected in the Consolidated Balance Sheets arose from the parent company’s acquisition of the bank (in 1968) and the acquisition of Sterling Resource Funding Corp (in 2006). Goodwill is deemed to have an indefinite useful life and therefore is not amortized, and the Company is required to complete an annual assessment for any impairment of goodwill. Impairment exists when a reporting unit’s carrying value of goodwill exceeds its fair value. The Company has selected December 31 as the date to perform the annual impairment testing. The impairment would be treated as an expense in the income statement. There was no impairment expense recorded in 2012, 2011 or 2010.
 
Goodwill is the only intangible asset with an indefinite life on our balance sheet and is tested for impairment using either a qualitative method or a two-step approach under ASU 2011-08 that initially involves the estimation of its respective fair value. If the fair value of a reporting unit is less than the carrying value of the reporting unit, a goodwill impairment loss
 
 
PAGE 66

 
 
would be recognized as a charge to expense for any excess of the goodwill carrying amount over its implied fair value.
 
Other intangible assets consist of acquired customer contracts and assets arising from a purchase of assets as of April 6, 2009. They were initially measured at fair value and then amortized on a straight-line method over their estimated useful life of two years.
 
(j) Premises and Equipment
Premises and equipment, excluding land, are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation or amortization as applicable. Land is reported at cost. Depreciation is computed on a straight-line basis and is charged to noninterest expense over the estimated useful lives of the related assets. Useful lives are seven years for furniture, fixtures and equipment, between three and seven years for ATMs, computer hardware and software, and ten years for building improvements. Amorti­zation of leasehold improvements is charged to noninterest expense over the terms of the respective leases or the estimated useful lives of the improvements, whichever is shorter. Maintenance, repairs and minor improvements are charged to noninterest expenses as incurred.
 
(k) Foreclosed Assets
Assets acquired through or instead of loan foreclosure are held for sale and are initially recorded at fair value less estimated selling costs when acquired, establishing a new cost basis. Costs after acquisition are generally expensed. If the fair value of the asset declines, a write-down is recorded through expense. The valuation of foreclosed assets is subjective in nature and may be adjusted in the future because of changes in economic conditions.
 
(l) Cash Surrender Value of Life Insurance Policies
The bank invested in Bank Owned Life Insurance (“BOLI”) policies to fund certain future employee benefit costs. In addition, the parent company and the bank own endorse­ment split-dollar life insurance policies on certain key executives. Changes in the cash surrender value, net of surrender charges, of BOLI policies are recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income under the caption “Income from bank owned life insurance policies.” Changes in the cash surrender value, net of surrender charges, of the endorsement split-dollar life insurance policies are netted against premium expense in the Consolidated Statements of Income under the caption “Employee Benefits.”
 
(m) Repurchase Agreements
The Company sells certain securities under agreements to repurchase and receives cash as collateral. The agreements are treated as collateralized financing transactions and the obligations to repurchase securities sold are reflected as a liability in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. The carrying value of the securities underlying the agreements remains reflected as an asset.
 
(n) Derivative Financial Instruments
The Company may be required to recognize certain contracts and commitments as derivatives when the characteristics of those contracts and commitments meet the definition of a derivative.
 
(o) Impact of Recent Economic Conditions
Current economic conditions, including illiquid credit markets, volatile equity, foreign currency and energy markets, and reduced consumer spending, have combined to increase risk and uncertainty across industries. The Company considers economic conditions and their impact on the financial results and operations of the Company discussed above, including the determination of fair value of investment securities or derivative financial instruments the Company holds, the establishment of allowance for loan losses, the impairment of any asset and any other amounts reported in the financial statements of the Company that may be affected in the near term.
 
(p) Income Taxes
The Company utilizes the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes. Deferred income tax expense (benefit) is determined by recognizing deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. The realization of deferred tax assets is assessed and a valuation allowance provided for that portion of the assets for which it is more likely than not that it will not be realized. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates and will be adjusted for the effects of future changes in tax laws or rates, if any.
 
For income tax purposes, the parent company files: a con­solidated Federal income tax return; combined New York City and New York State income tax returns; and separate state income tax returns for its out-of-state subsidiaries. The parent company, under tax sharing agreements, either pays or collects current income taxes due to or due from its subsidiaries.
 
Starting in 2009, New York State Tax law generally requires a REIT that is majority owned by a New York State bank to be included in the bank’s combined New York State tax return. The Company believes that it qualifies for the small-bank exception to this rule. If, contrary to this belief, Sterling Real Estate Holding Company, Inc. were required to be included in the Company’s New York State combined tax return, the Company’s effective tax rate would increase.
 
 
PAGE 67

 
 
Under the small-bank exception, dividends received by the bank from SREHC, a real estate investment trust, are subject to a 60% dividends-received deduction, which results in only 40% of the dividends being subject to New York State tax. Currently, the New York City banking corporation tax operates in the same manner in this respect.
 
(q) Statements of Cash Flows
For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash and amounts due from banks. Net cash flows are reported for customer loan and deposit transactions, interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions, federal funds purchased and repurchase agreements.
 
(r) Stock Incentive Plan
The Company's share-based employee compensation plan, which is described more fully in Note 16, expired during 2012.
 
Employee stock options generally expire ten years from the date of grant and become non-forfeitable one year from date of grant, although if necessary to qualify to the maximum extent possible as incentive stock options, these options become exercisable in annual installments. Director non­qualified stock options generally expire five years from the date of grant and become non-forfeitable and become exer­cisable in four annual installments starting one year from the date of grant. Share-based compensation is recognized in compensation expense as described more fully in Note 17 over the period from the date of grant to the date on which the options become non-forfeitable.
 
(s) Earnings Per Common Share
Earnings per common share is computed using the two-class method. Basic earnings per common share is computed by dividing net earnings allocated to common shareholders by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the applicable period, excluding participating securities. Participating securities include non-vested share awards such as awards of restricted shares of common shares. Non-vested share awards are considered participating securities because holders of these securities receive non-forfeitable dividends at the same rate as holders of the Company’s common shares. Diluted earnings per common share is computed using the weighted-average number of shares determined for the basic earnings per common share computation plus the dilutive effect of stock option compensation using the treasury stock method.
 
(t) Disclosures About Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information
“Segment Reporting” topic of the FASB Accounting Standards Codification establishes standards for the way business enterprises report information about operating segments and establishes standards for related disclosure about products and services, geographic areas and major customers. The statement requires that a business enterprise report financial and descriptive information about its reportable operating segments. Operating segments are components of an enterprise about which separate financial information is available that is evaluated regularly by the chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assess performance.
 
During the latter half of 2011, the Company combined its operating segments into one reportable segment, “Community Banking.” All of the Company’s activities are interrelated and each activity is dependent and assessed based on the manner in which it supports the other activities of the Company. For example, lending is dependent upon the ability of the bank to fund itself with retail deposits and other borrowings and to manage interest rate and credit risk. Accordingly, all significant operating decisions are based upon analysis of the Company as one operating segment or unit. The Company derives a substantial portion of its revenue and income from providing banking and related financial services and products to customers located primarily in the New York metropolitan area. The financial information in this report reflects the single segment through which the Company conducts its business.
 
 
PAGE 68

 

NOTE 2.
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS
 
The Company maintains deposits with other financial institutions in amounts that exceed federal deposit insurance coverage. Management regularly evaluates the credit risk associated with the counterparties to these transactions and believes that the Company is not exposed to any significant credit risks.
 
The bank is required to maintain average reserves, net of vault cash, on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank of New York against outstanding domestic deposits and certain other liabilities. The reserves maintained, which are reported in cash and due from banks, were $111.1 million and $124.6 million at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively. Average required reserves during 2012 and 2011 were $4.3 million and $4.6 million, respectively.
 
For the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010, the Company received interest from the Federal Reserve amounting to $132 thousand, $228 thousand and $76 thousand, respectively.
 
NOTE 3.
MONEY MARKET INVESTMENTS
 
The Company’s money market investments include interest-bearing deposits with other banks and Federal funds sold. The following table presents information regarding money market investments.
 
Years Ended December 31,
   
2012
       
2011
       
2010
 
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
                           
At December 31   —Balance
$   112,886     $   126,448     $   40,503  
—Weighted average interest rate
    0.25%         0.25%         0.25%  
—Weighted average original maturity (Days)
   
3
       
3
       
7
 
During the year    —Maximum month-end balance
    174,808         262,940         66,858  
—Daily average balance
    58,836         93,561         31,960  
—Weighted average interest rate earned
    0.23%         0.24%         0.23%  
—Range of interest rates earned
  0.03 0.80%     0.03 0.90%     0.06 1.50%
 
 
PAGE 69

 

NOTE 4.
INVESTMENT SECURITIES
 
The amortized cost and fair value of securities available for sale are as follows:
 
December 31, 2012
 
Amortized
Cost
   
Gross Unrealized Gains
   
Gross Unrealized Losses
   
Fair
Value
 
U.S. Treasury securities
  $
6,387
    $ 1     $ 2     $ 6,386  
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                             
 Residential mortgage-backed securities
                             
  CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    19,615       47       30       19,632  
  CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
    3,293       12       14       3,291  
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    1,860       118             1,978  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    20             1       19  
  Government National Mortgage Association
    85       1             86  
 Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    24,873       178       45       25,006  
 Agency notes
                               
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    650       1             651  
  Federal Home Loan Bank
    500       1             501  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    75       4             79  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    26,098       184       45       26,237  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
    16,499       1,424             17,923  
Single-issuer, trust preferred securities
    37,875       1,090       80       38,885  
Other preferred securities
    12,012       3       62       11,953  
Corporate debt securities
    173,332       1,288       202       174,418  
Equity and other securities
    19,371       2,129       465       21,035  
  Total
  $ 291,574     $ 6,119     $ 856     $ 296,837  
                                 
December 31, 2011
                               
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                               
 Residential mortgage-backed securities
                               
  CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
  $ 21,642     $ 103     $ 6     $ 21,739  
  CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
    5,666       12       11       5,667  
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    2,137       74             2,211  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    38             1       37  
  Government National Mortgage Association
    98                   98  
 Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    29,581       189       18       29,752  
 Agency notes
                               
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    501                   501  
  Federal Home Loan Bank
    101       1             102  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    376       7             383  
  Federal Farm Credit Bank
    251                   251  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    30,810       197       18       30,989  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
    21,171       1,606             22,777  
Single-issuer trust preferred securities
    28,506       214       1,661       27,059  
Corporate debt securities
    175,920       263       2,876       173,307  
Equity and other securities
    15,322       958       398       15,882  
  Total
  $ 271,729     $ 3,238     $ 4,953     $ 270,014  
 
 
PAGE 70

 
 
The carrying value and fair value of securities held to maturity are as follows:
 
December 31, 2012
 
Carrying
Value
   
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
   
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
   
Fair
Value
 
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                       
 Residential mortgage-backed securities
                       
  CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)
  $ 2,051     $
88
    $
 —
    $ 2,139  
  CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    3,525       145             3,670  
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    32,731       2,854             35,585  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    15,768       1,237             17,005  
  Government National Mortgage Association
    3,385       559             3,944  
 Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    57,460       4,883             62,343  
 Agency notes
                               
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    95,977       95       74       95,998  
  Federal Home Loan Bank
    81,989       38       12       82,015  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    15,000       21             15,021  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    250,426       5,037       86       255,377  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
    135,982       11,861       2       147,841  
 Total
  $ 386,408     $ 16,898     $
88
    $ 403,218  
                                 
December 31, 2011
                               
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                               
 Residential mortgage-backed securities
                               
  CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)
  $ 3,942     $
192
    $
    $ 4,134  
  CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    6,474       305             6,779  
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    46,937       3,777             50,714  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    23,682       1,669             25,351  
  Government National Mortgage Association
    4,132       603             4,735  
 Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    85,167       6,546             91,713  
 Agency notes
                               
  Federal National Mortgage Association
    104,981       203             105,184  
  Federal Home Loan Bank
    44,992       34             45,026  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    34,991       49       9       35,031  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    270,131       6,832       9       276,954  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
    137,726       11,105       10       148,821  
 Total
  $ 407,857     $ 17,937     $
19
    $ 425,775  
 
The Company invests principally in obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises and other investment-grade securities. The fair value of these investments fluctuates based on several factors, including credit quality and general interest rate changes. The Company determined that it is not more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell any investments before anticipated recovery.
 
 
PAGE 71

 
 
At December 31, 2012, approximately $137.3 million, representing approximately 20.1%, of the Company’s held to maturity and available for sale securities are comprised of securities issued by financial service companies/banks including single-issuer trust preferred securities (24 issuers), corporate debt (39 issuers), other preferred securities (3 issuers) and equity and other securities (14 issuers). These investments may pose a higher risk of future impairment charges as a result of a lack of significant improvement of the U.S. economy and/or a further deterioration in stock prices of the companies in the financial services industry. The Company would be required to recognize impairment charges on these securities if they suffer a decline in value that is considered other than temporary. Numerous factors, including lack of liquidity for re-sales of certain investment securities, absence of reliable pricing information for investment securities, adverse changes in business climate, adverse actions by regulators, or unanticipated changes in the competitive environment could have a negative effect on the Company’s investment portfolio and may result in other-than-temporary impairment on certain investment securities in future periods.
 
The following table presents information regarding securities available for sale with temporary unrealized losses for the periods indicated:
 
   
Less Than 12 Months
   
12 Months or Longer
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
December 31, 2012
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
U.S. Treasury securities
  $ 388     $
2
    $     $
    $ 388     $
2
 
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                                         
 Residential mortgage-backed securities
                                         
  CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    5,876       12       2,314       18       8,190       30  
  CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
                1,518       14       1,518       14  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
                19       1       19       1  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    5,876       12       3,851       33       9,727       45  
Single-issuer trust preferred securities
    9,698       71       1,079       9       10,777       80  
Other preferred securities
    11,849       62                   11,849       62  
Corporate debt securities
    35,832       73       10,667       129       46,499       202  
Equity and other securities
    2,476       316       1,057       149       3,533       465  
 Total
  $ 66,119     $
536
    $ 16,654     $
320
    $ 82,773     $
856
 
                                                 
December 31, 2011
                                               
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                                               
 Residential mortgage-backed securities
                                               
  CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
  $ 4,276     $ 6     $     $
    $ 4,276     $
6
 
  CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
    3,448       11                   3,448       11  
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
                22       1       22       1  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    7,724       17       22       1       7,746       18  
Single-issuer trust preferred securities
    11,721       1,574       415       87       12,136       1,661  
Corporate debt securities
    139,972       1,937       10,607       939       150,579       2,876  
Equity and other securities
    2,974       398                   2,974       398  
 Total
  $ 162,391     $ 3,926     $ 11,044     $
1,027
    $ 173,435     $
4,953
 
 
At December 31, 2012, the Company held three positions in residential mortgage-backed securities issued by the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (two) and Government National Mortgage Association (one) in the available for sale portfolio that were in unrealized loss positions for more than 12 months. The amount of the unrealized loss ($33 thousand) was insignificant to the Company’s results of operations for the year ended December 31, 2012.
 
 
PAGE 72

 
 
The following table presents information regarding single-issuer, trust preferred securities at December 31, 2012:
 
Issuer
TARP Recipient
Credit Rating
 
Amortized Cost
   
Fair Value
   
Unreal­ized Gain/(Loss)
 
Sterling Bancorp Trust I, 8.375%, due 3/31/2032
Yes*
NA
  $ 991     $ 1,046     $ 55  
NPB Capital Trust II, 7.85%, due 9/30/2032
Yes*
NA
    126       129       3  
Allfirst Pfd Cap Trust, Floating Rate, due 7/15/2029, owned by M&T Bank Corporation 
Yes*
BBB
    381       400       19  
Capital One Capital II, 7.50%, due 1/02/2013
Yes*
BB+
    7,724       7,673       (51 )
Capital One Capital VI, 8.875%, due 5/15/2040
Yes*
BB+
    103       100       (3 )
Citigroup Capital VII, 7.125%, due 7/31/2031
Yes*
BB
    1,507       1,523       16  
Citigroup Capital VIII, 6.95%, due 9/15/2031
Yes*
BB
    246       252       6  
Citigroup Capital IX, 6.00%, due 2/14/2033
Yes*
BB
    2,887       2,997       110  
Citigroup Capital X, 6.10%, due 9/30/2033
Yes*
BB
    830       834       4  
Citigroup Capital XI, 6.00%, due 9/27/2034
Yes*
BB
    149       149        
Citigroup Capital XVII, 6.35%, due 3/15/2067
Yes*
BB
    46       62       16  
First Tennessee Capital II, 6.30%, due 4/15/2034
Yes*
BB
    4,617       4,748       131  
Goldman Sachs Capital I, 6.345%, due 2/15/2034
Yes*
BB+
    8,911       9,342       431  
Keycorp Capital II, 6.875%, due 3/17/2029
Yes*
BBB-
    93       95       2  
Mellon Capital IV, 4.00%, due 6/20/2049
Yes*
BBB
    118       118        
JP Morgan Chase Capital XIII, Floating Rate, due 9/30/2034
Yes*
BBB
    760       821       61  
JP Morgan Chase Capital XI, 5.875%, due 6/15/2033
Yes*
BBB
    1,623       1,636       13  
Morgan Stanley Capital Trust III, 6.25%, due 3/01/2033
Yes*
BB+
    1,044       1,116       72  
SunTrust Capital I, Floating Rate, due 5/15/2027
Yes*
BB+
    731       798       67  
USB Capital IX, 3.50% due 10/29/2049
Yes*
BBB+
    90       90        
VNB Capital Trust I, 7.75%, due 12/15/2031
Yes*
BBB-
    21       21        
Wells Fargo Capital Trust VII, 5.85%, due 5/01/2033
Yes*
BBB+
    424       433       9  
Wells Fargo Capital Trust VIII, 5.625%, due 8/01/2033
Yes*
BBB+
    367       380       13  
Wells Fargo Capital IX, 5.625%, due 4/08/2034
Yes*
BBB+
    4,086       4,122       36  
        $ 37,875     $ 38,885     $ 1,010  
 
*TARP obligation was repaid prior to December 31, 2012.
 
 
PAGE 73

 
 
At December 31, 2012, the Company held 24 security positions of single-issuer bank trust preferred securities, 39 security positions of corporate debt securities and three positions of other preferred securities issued by financial institutions all of which are paying in accordance with their terms and have no deferrals of interest or other deferrals. In addition, management analyzes the performance of the issuers on a quarterly basis, including a review of the issuer’s most recent bank regulatory report to assess credit risk and the probability of impairment of the contractual cash flows of the applicable securities. Based upon management’s fourth quarter review, all of the ­issuers have maintained performance levels adequate to support the contractual cash flows of the securities.
 
As of December 31, 2012, management does not have the intent to sell any of the securities classified as available for sale in the tables above and believes that it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell any such securities before recovery of cost.
 
The following table presents information regarding securities held to maturity with temporary unrealized losses for the periods indicated:
 
   
Less Than 12 Months
   
12 Months or Longer
   
Total
 
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
   
Fair
   
Unrealized
 
December 31, 2012
 
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
   
Value
   
Losses
 
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                                   
 Agency Notes
                                   
  Federal National Mortgage Association
  $ 14,926     $ 74     $     $     $ 14,926     $ 74  
  Federal Home Loan Bank
    32,987       12                   32,987       12  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    47,913       86                   47,913       86  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
    203       2                   203       2  
   Total
  $ 48,116     $ 88     $     $     $ 48,116     $ 88  
                                                 
December 31, 2011
                                               
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                                               
 Agency Notes
                                               
  Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
  $ 14,991     $
9
    $     $     $ 14,991     $ 9  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    14,991       9                   14,991       9  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
    736       9       289       1       1,025       10  
   Total
  $ 15,727     $ 18     $ 289     $
1
    $ 16,016     $ 19  
 
At December 31, 2012, the Company held no security position in obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises and obligations of state and political institutions in the held to maturity portfolio that were in an unrealized loss position for more than 12 months.
 
 
PAGE 74

 
 
The following tables present information regarding securities available for sale and securities held to maturity at December 31, 2012, based on contractual maturity. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
 
   
Available for sale
   
Held to maturity
 
   
Amortized
   
Fair
   
Amortized
   
Fair
 
   
Cost
   
Value
   
Cost
   
Value
 
U.S. Treasury securities
  $ 6,387     $ 6,386     $     $  
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                               
Residential mortgage-backed securities
                               
CMOs (Federal National Mortgage Association)
                2,051       2,139  
CMOs (Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation)
    19,615       19,632       3,525       3,670  
CMOs (Government National Mortgage Association)
    3,293       3,291              
Federal National Mortgage Association
    1,860       1,978       32,731       35,585  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
    20       19       15,768       17,005  
Government National Mortgage Association
    85       86       3,385       3,944  
Total residential mortgage-backed securities
    24,873       25,006       57,460       62,343  
Agency notes
                               
Federal National Mortgage Association
                               
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    650       651       10,000       10,007  
Due after 10 years
                85,977       85,991  
Federal Home Loan Bank
                               
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    250       251              
Due after 5 years but within 10 years     250       250              
Due after 10 years
                81,989       82,015  
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation
                               
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
    75       79              
Due after 10 years
                15,000       15,021  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
    26,098       26,237       250,426       255,377  
Obligations of state and political institutions
                               
Due after 1 year but within 5 years
                155       167  
Due after 5 years but within 10 years
    3,355       3,632       9,267       10,232  
Due after 10 years
    13,144       14,291       126,560       137,442  
Total obligations of state and political institutions
    16,499       17,923       135,982       147,841  
Single-issuer trust preferred securities
                               
Due within 1 year
    7,724       7,673              
Due after 10 years
    30,151       31,212              
Total single-issuer trust preferred securities
    37,875       38,885              
Other preferred securities
                               
Due within 1 year
    11,910       11,849              
Due after 10 years
    102       104              
Total other preferred securities
    12,012       11,953              
Corporate debt securities
                               
Due within 6 months
    51,690       51,705              
Due after 6 months but within 1 year
    47,689       47,926              
Due after 1 year but within 2 years
    54,872       55,484              
Due after 2 years but within 5 years
    16,430       16,532              
Due after 5 years but within 10 years
    2,552       2,664              
Due after 10 years
    99       107              
Total corporate debt securities
    173,332       174,418              
Equity and other securities
    19,371       21,035              
Total
  $ 291,574     $ 296,837     $ 386,408     $ 403,218  
 
 
PAGE 75

 
 
Information regarding sales and/or calls of held to maturity securities is as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Sales:
                 
 Proceeds
  $     $ 2,141     $  
 Gross gains
          62        
 Gross losses
                 
Calls:
                       
 Proceeds
    266,162       322,500       142,380  
 Gross gains
    56       104       368  
 Gross losses
    6       76        
 
During 2012 and 2010, there were no sales of held to maturity securities. During 2011, $2.1 million of mortgage-backed securities issued by the Federal National Mortgage Association were sold out of the held to maturity portfolio. Each of the securities sold had been paid down by more than 85% of its original cost.
 
Information regarding sales and/or calls of the available for sale securities is as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Sales:
                 
Proceeds
  $ 119,672     $ 181,116     $ 169,517  
Gross gains
    1,195       2,569       3,703  
Gross losses
    3       311        
Calls:
                       
Proceeds
    62,095       105,160       316,674  
Gross gains
    637       143       145  
Gross losses
    66             288  
 
Investment securities are pledged to secure trust and public deposits, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, borrowings from the Federal Home Loan Bank of New York and/or the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, and for other purposes required or permitted by law.
 
NOTE 5.
LOANS AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES
 
The major components of domestic loans held for sale and loans held in portfolio are as follows:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Loans held for sale, net of valuation reserve ($-0- at December 31, 2012 and $-0- at December 31, 2011)
           
Real estate—residential mortgage
  $ 121,237     $ 43,372  
Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts
               
Commercial and industrial
    629,369       626,063  
Loans to nondepository institutions
    348,843       246,587  
Factored receivables
    151,830       172,082  
Equipment financing receivables
    177,084       166,690  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    151,609       170,153  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    182,735       85,825  
Real estate—construction and land development
    13,277       13,621  
Loans to individuals
    11,851       10,376  
Loans to depository institutions
          10  
Loans held in portfolio, gross
    1,666,598       1,491,407  
Less unearned discounts
    16,845       18,098  
Loans held in portfolio, net of unearned discounts
    1,649,753       1,473,309  
    $ 1,770,990     $ 1,516,681  

 
PAGE 76

 
 
At December 31, 2012, the bank had qualified loans, with a carrying value of approximately $446.4 million, available to secure borrowings from the FHLB and the FRB; no loans were pledged at December 31, 2012. At December 31, 2011, $478.9 million of loans were pledged to secure FHLB and FRB borrowings.
 
Loan Origination/Risk Management
The Company has lending policies and procedures in place that are designed to maximize loan income within an acceptable level of risk. Management reviews and approves these policies and procedures on a regular basis. A reporting system supplements the review process by providing management with frequent reports related to loan production, loan quality, concentrations of credit, loan delinquencies and non-performing and potential problem loans. Diversification in the loan portfolio is a means of managing risk associated with fluctuations in economic conditions.
 
The Company maintains an independent loan review process that reviews and validates the credit risk program on a periodic basis. Results of these reviews are presented to management and the Loan Committee of the Board of Directors. The loan review process complements and reinforces the risk identification and assessment decisions made by lenders.
 
Commercial and Loans to Nondepository Institutions
Sterling provides a full range of loans to small and medium-sized businesses with the objective of establishing longer-term relationships. Loans generally range in size up to $20 million, tailored to meet customers’ long- and short-term needs, and include secured and unsecured lines of credit and business installment loans.
 
Loans generally are collateralized by accounts receivable, inventory, mortgages on residential real estate and other assets. Sterling also provides back-office services, i.e., processing payroll, generating customer invoices, credit collection assistance and related payroll services. The repayment of commercial loans is generally dependent on the creditworthiness and cash flow of borrowers and guarantors, which may be negatively impacted by adverse economic conditions. While these loans are secured, collateral type, marketability, coverage, valuation and monitoring is not as uniform as in other portfolio classes and recovery from liquidation of such collateral may be subject to greater variability.
 
Factoring
Factoring provides a financing service that combines working capital financing, credit risk protection, and accounts receivable management for companies in a variety of industries. This business may be conducted on a recourse or non-recourse basis, depending upon the needs of the client.
 
In general, Sterling records a receivable for the amount of accounts receivables due from customers of its clients and records a liability for the funds due to the client. Under advance factoring arrangements, clients can draw an advance as accounts receivables are sold/assigned to Sterling. With advance factoring, Sterling normally has recourse against the client if the customer fails to pay. Under collection factoring arrangements, clients sell Sterling their accounts receivables and Sterling provides credit protection to the client guaranteeing the collection of the amount due and back office support. Collection factoring is generally under a nonrecourse basis where the principal source of payment for Sterling is through the collection of the receivable from our client’s customer whose credit has been approved by Sterling following a rigorous review process. Also, with collection factoring, Sterling has credit default insurance with a nationally recognized insurance company to provide it with protection against customer default.
 
Commercial Real Estate
Sterling offers a range of commercial real estate lending including financing on commercial buildings, retail properties and mixed use properties. Loans are predicated on cash flow of the property, the value of the property determined by an independent appraisal and the strength of personal guarantees, if any. Loans are made at fixed or floating rates. Floating rate loans are based on the prime rate. Fixed rate loans are tied to Treasury or FHLB benchmarks and other indices.
 
Commercial real estate loans are subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial and industrial loans, in addition to those of real estate loans. These loans are viewed primarily as cash flow loans and secondarily as loans secured by real estate. Commercial real estate lending typically involves higher loan principal amounts and the repayment of these loans is generally dependent on the successful operation of the property securing the loan or the business conducted on the property securing the loan. Commercial real estate loans may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing the Company’s real estate portfolio are diverse in terms of type and geographic location. This diversity helps reduce the Company’s exposure to adverse economic events that affect a single market or industry. Management monitors and evaluates commercial real estate loans based on collateral, geographic and risk grade criteria.
 
With respect to loans to developers and builders that are secured by non-owner occupied properties that the Company may originate from time to time, the Company generally requires the borrower to have had an existing relationship
 
 
PAGE 77

 
 
with the Company and have a record of success. Construction loans are underwritten utilizing feasibility studies, independent appraisal reviews, sensitivity analysis of absorption and lease rates and financial analysis of the developers and property owners. Construction loans are generally based upon estimates of costs and value associated with funds, with repayment substantially dependent on the success of the ultimate project. Sources of repayment for these types of loans may be pre-committed permanent loans from approved long-term lenders, sales of developed property or an interim loan commitment from the Company until permanent financing is obtained. These loans are closely monitored by on-site inspections and are considered to have higher risks than other real estate loans due to their ultimate repayment being sensitive to timely completion of the project, interest rate changes, government regulation of real property, general conditions and the availability of long-term financing.
 
Loans are made at fixed or floating rates. Fixed rate loans are tied to U.S. Treasury or FHLB benchmarks or other indices. Floating rate loans are based on the prime rate or other index.  
 
Equipment Financing
Sterling engages in direct lending and indirect lending. Direct lending is when requests for financing originate with an end user seeking to finance equipment up to 60 months. Indirect lending arises through relationships with equipment financing brokers.
 
In both cases, credit approval is based upon a full underwriting process that involves the submission of financial and other information, including the applicant’s historical performance, cash flow projections and value of equipment, and for customers who are not public entities, Sterling generally obtains the personal guarantees of the principals of the entities.
 
Residential Mortgage
Residential mortgage loans, principally on single-family residences, are made primarily for re-sale into the secondary market. Offering both fixed and adjustable rate residential mortgage loan products, mortgages are focused on conforming credit, government insured FHA and other high quality loan products. Jumbo loans are also originated for sale into the secondary market, or brokered to third-party providers.
 
The ability of borrowers to service debt in the residential mortgage loan portfolios is generally subject to personal income, which may be impacted by general economic conditions, such as increased unemployment levels. These loans are predominantly collateralized by first and second liens on single family properties. If a borrower cannot maintain the loan, the Company’s ability to recover against the collateral in sufficient amount and in a timely manner may be significantly influenced by market, legal and regulatory conditions.
 
Concentrations of Credit
At December 31, 2012, there are no industry concentrations, other than loans to nondepository institutions (exceeding 10% of loans, gross) of loans held in portfolio. Loans to nondepository institutions, which includes the Company’s residential mortgage warehouse funding product and loans to finance companies, represented approximately 20% of all loans. Approximately 67% of loans were to borrowers located in the New York metropolitan area. A further deterioration in economic conditions within the region, including a decline in real estate values, higher unemployment and other factors, which could adversely impact small and mid-sized businesses, could have a significant adverse impact on the quality of the Company’s loan portfolio. In addition, a decline in real estate values and higher unemployment within the mid-Atlantic region and North Carolina could adversely impact the Company’s residential real estate loan portfolio.
 
Approximately 29.0% or $39.1 million and 21.1% or $26.9 million of the Company’s net interest income and noninterest income are related to real estate lending in 2012 and 2011, respectively. Real estate prices in the U.S. market have decreased significantly from pre-crisis levels. Further declines in real estate values could necessitate charge-offs in our mortgage loan portfolio that may impact our operating results. In addition, a sustained period of declining real estate values combined with the continued turbulence in the financial and credit markets would continue to limit our mortgage related revenues.
 
As of December 31, 2012, approximately 59.1% of the Company’s loan portfolio consisted of commercial and industrial, factored receivables, construction and commercial real estate loans. Because the Company’s loan portfolio contains a number of commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loans with relatively large balances, the deterioration of one or a few of these loans could cause a significant increase in nonperforming loans.
 
Related Party Loans
Loans are made to officers or directors (including their immediate families) of the Company or for the benefit of corporations in which they have a beneficial interest subject to applicable regulations. There were no outstanding balances on such loans in excess of $60 thousand to any individual or entity at December 31, 2012 or 2011.
 
 
PAGE 78

 

Nonperforming Loans
Nonaccrual loans are those on which the accrual of interest has ceased. Loans, including loans that are individually identified as being impaired under FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables, are generally placed on nonaccrual status immediately if, in the opinion of management, principal or interest is not likely to be paid in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement, or when principal or interest is past due 90 days or more and collateral, if any, is insufficient to cover principal and interest. Interest accrued but not collected at the date a loan is placed on nonaccrual status is reversed against interest income. Interest income is recognized on nonaccrual loans only to the extent received in cash. Where there is doubt regarding the ultimate collectibility of the loan principal, cash receipts, whether designated as principal or interest, are thereafter applied to reduce the carrying value of the loan. Loans are restored to accrual status when interest and principal payments are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.
 
Nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2012 and 2011 totaled $5.9 million and $6.4 million, respectively. The interest income that would have been earned on nonaccrual loans outstanding at December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010, in accordance with their original terms, is estimated to be $819 thousand, $780 thousand and $902 thousand, respectively, for the years then ended. Applicable interest income actually realized was $61 thousand, $200 thousand and $204 thousand, respectively, for the aforementioned years, and there were no commitments to lend additional funds on nonaccrual loans.
 
The following table sets forth the amount of nonaccrual loans of the Company at the end of each of the two most recent fiscal years:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Nonaccrual loans
           
 Commercial and industrial
  $ 2,495     $ 834  
 Factored receivables
           
 Equipment financing receivables
    339       370  
 Real estate—residential mortgage
    2,325       1,991  
 Real estate—commercial mortgage
    745       3,124  
 Real estate—construction and land development
           
 Loans to individuals
    18       39  
 Total nonaccrual loans
  $ 5,922     $ 6,358  
 
The following tables provide information regarding the past due status of loans for the periods indicated:
 
December 31, 2012
 
30–59 Days Past Due
   
60–89 Days Past Due
   
90 & Over Past Due
   
Total Past Due
   
Current
   
Total Loans
   
MEMO
90 & Over and Still Accruing
 
Commercial and industrial
  $ 28,711     $ 7,541     $ 2,641     $ 38,893     $ 588,892     $ 627,785     $ 146  
Loans to nondepository institutions
                            348,809       348,809        
Factored receivables
    3,122       1,339       99       4,560       147,033       151,593       99  
Equipment financing receivables
    159       284       339       782       161,312       162,094        
Real estate—residential mortgage
    1,464       1,208       2,325       4,997       146,612       151,609        
Real estate—commercial mortgage
                745       745       181,990       182,735        
Real estate—construction and land development
                            13,277       13,277        
Loans to individuals
    9       17       18       44       11,807       11,851        
Loans to depository institutions
                                         
Total loans, net of unearned discount
  $ 33,465     $ 10,389     $ 6,167     $ 50,021     $ 1,599,732     $ 1,649,753     $ 245  
 
 
PAGE 79

 
 
December 31, 2011
 
30–59 Days Past Due
   
60–89 Days Past Due
   
90 & Over Past Due
   
Total Past Due
   
Current
   
Total Loans
   
MEMO
90 & Over and Still Accruing
 
Commercial and industrial
  $ 23,665     $ 5,344     $ 837     $ 29,846     $ 594,278     $ 624,124     $ 165  
Loans to nondepository institutions
                            246,587       246,587        
Factored receivables
    3,266       665       162       4,093       167,738       171,831        
Equipment financing receivables
    546       386       370       1,302       149,480       150,782        
Real estate—residential mortgage
    1,570       633       1,991       4,194       165,959       170,153        
Real estate—commercial mortgage
                3,124       3,124       82,701       85,825        
Real estate—construction and land development
                            13,621       13,621        
Loans to individuals
    41       7       39       87       10,289       10,376        
Loans to depository institutions
                            10       10        
Total loans, net of unearned discount
  $ 29,088     $ 7,035     $ 6,523     $ 42,646     $ 1,430,663     $ 1,473,309     $ 165  

Impaired Loans
Management considers a loan to be impaired when, based on current information and events, it is determined that the Company will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the loan contract, including scheduled interest payments. Determination of impairment is treated the same across all classes of loans on a loan-by-loan basis. When management identifies a loan as impaired, the impairment is measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, except when the sole remaining source of repayment of the loan is the operation or liquidation of the collateral. In these cases management uses the current fair value of the collateral, less selling costs when foreclosure is probable, instead of discounted cash flows. If management determines that the value of the impaired loan is less than the recorded investment in the loan (net of previous charge-offs, deferred loan fees or costs and unamortized premium or discount), impairment is recognized through an allowance estimate or a charge-off to the allowance.
 
When the ultimate collectibility of the total principal of an impaired loan is in doubt and the loan is on nonaccrual status, all payments are applied to principal, under the cost recovery method. When the ultimate collectibility of the total principal of an impaired loan is not in doubt and the loan is on nonaccrual status, contractual interest is credited to interest income when received, under the cash basis method. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.
 
The following tables include the recorded investment and unpaid principal balances for impaired financing receivables with the associated allowance amount, if applicable. Management determined the specific allowance based on the present value of the expected future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, except when the remaining source of repayment for the loan is the operation or liquidation of the collateral. In those cases, the current fair value of the collateral less selling costs was used to determine the specific allowance recorded.
 
December 31, 2012
 
Recorded Investment in Impaired Loans
   
Principal Balance With No Allowance
   
Principal Balance With Allowance
   
Related
Allowance
   
Average Recorded Investment in Impaired Loans
 
Commercial and industrial
  $ 2,406     $ 1,956     $ 1,558     $
325
    $ 1,690  
Loans to nondepository institutions
                             
Factored receivables
                             
Equipment financing receivables
    89             89       7       132  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    6,152       1,955       5,945       1,592       5,698  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    745             745       350       2,038  
Real estate—construction and land development
                             
Loans to individuals
                             
Loans to depository institutions
                             
 Total
  $ 9,392     $ 3,911     $ 8,337     $ 2,274     $ 9,558  
 
 
PAGE 80

 
 
December 31, 2011
 
Recorded Investment in Impaired Loans
   
Principal Balance With No Allowance
   
Principal Balance With Allowance
   
Related
Allowance
   
Average Recorded Investment in Impaired Loans
 
Commercial and industrial
  $ 2,954     $ 1,395     $
2,159
    $
287
    $ 2,596  
Loans to nondepository institutions
                             
Factored receivables
                             
Equipment financing receivables
    151             151       17       230  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    5,275       825       4,966       1,234       4,886  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    3,124             3,124       1,113       3,124  
Real estate—construction and land development
                             
Loans to individuals
                             
Loans to depository institutions
                             
 Total
  $ 11,504     $ 2,220     $ 10,400     $ 2,651     $ 10,836  
 
The recognition of interest income on accruing impaired loans is based upon an individual assessment of each loan; however, interest income is not accrued on a loan that is more than 90 days past due. Interest income recognized on these loans during impairment was approximately $321 thousand (equipment financing receivables $5 thousand and real estate–residential mortgage $316 thousand), $430 thousand and $60 thousand for 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
The Company has allocated $1.6 million and $1.3 million of specific reserves to customers with equipment financing receivables and residential real estate loans whose loan terms have been modified in troubled debt restructurings ("TDRs") as of December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011. The Company has no commitments to lend additional amounts to customers with outstanding loans that are classified as TDRs.
 
During the year ended December 31, 2012, the terms of $2.4 million of residential real estate loans were modified as TDRs. The modification of terms of such loans included one or a combination of the following: a reduction of the stated interest rate; an extension of the maturity date at a stated rate of interest lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk; or a permanent reduction of the recorded investment in the loan. No lease financing receivables were modified during the twelve months ended December 31, 2012.
 
Modifications of residential real estate loans involving a reduction of the stated interest rate or an extension of the maturity date were for periods ranging up to 40 years.
 
The troubled debt restructurings described above increased the allowance for loan losses by $816 thousand for the twelve months ended December 31, 2012 and resulted in charge-offs of $275 thousand during the twelve months ended December 31, 2012.
 
During the twelve months ended December 31, 2012, 23 residential real estate loans with a recorded investment of $2.8 million had a payment default. No lease financing receivables had a payment default. A loan is considered to be in payment default once it is 60 days contractually past due under the modified terms.
 
 
PAGE 81

 

Credit Quality Indicators
As part of the ongoing monitoring of the credit quality of the Company’s loan portfolio, management tracks certain credit quality indicators including trends related to (i) the risk grade of loans, (ii) the level of classified loans, (iii) charge-offs, (iv) nonperforming loans and (v) the general economic conditions in the New York metropolitan area.
 
The Company categorizes loans into risk categories based on relevant information about the ability of borrowers to service their debt, such as: current financial information, historical payment experience, credit documentation, public information and current economic trends, among other factors. The Company has a process for analyzing non-homogeneous loans, such as commercial and commercial real estate loans, individually by grading the loans based on credit risk. This analysis occurs at varying times based on the type of loan, as well as the loan balance and occurs at least once every 18 months for those loans greater than $500,000.
 
For homogeneous loan pools, such as residential mortgages, leases and consumer loans, the Company uses payment status to identify the credit risk in these loan portfolios. Payment status is reviewed on a daily basis by the Company’s personnel and on a monthly basis with respect to determining the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. The payment status of these homogeneous pools at December 31, 2012 is included in the aging of the recorded investment of the past due loans table above. In addition, the total nonperforming portion of these homogeneous loan pools at December 31, 2012 is presented in the recorded investment in nonaccrual loans table above.
 
The Company utilizes a risk grading matrix to assign a risk grade to each of its commercial loans. Loans under $100,000 are not risk rated. Loans are graded on a scale of 1 to 9. A description of the general characteristics of the 9 risk grades is as follows:
•  Risk Rating 1 & 2/High Quality/Minimal Risk—These loans are well secured by liquid or high-quality, diversified, and readily marketable securities within the bank’s defined margin requirements including cash surrender value of life insurance, or loans to strong privately held obligors secured by real estate with satisfactory loan to value, and support guarantors. They could include loans to publicly traded entities with strong credit ratings (A-1 or better) by Moody’s or Standard & Poor’s.
•  Risk Rating 3 & 4/Very Good/Good Quality—These loans can be either unsecured or secured (with monthly monitoring of Accounts Receivable and/or Inventory) to adequately or moderately capitalized privately held obligors with satisfactory sales, revenue, earnings trends, cash flow, and leverage. These secured loans may be monitored in the Asset Based Lending or the Factoring Department to include control of cash receipts and defined formula advances. These categories could include loans to publicly traded entities with credit ratings of A-3 or lower by Moody’s or Standard & Poor’s.
•  Risk Rating 5/Watch List—These loans are to companies with uneven financial performance containing exceptions to loan policy without mitigating factors. Loans may receive this rating when the obligors experience temporary credit and/or structural deficiencies. Such credits have not been criticized by Loan Review. Close supervision is warranted to avoid further deterioration.
  Risk Rating 6/Special Mention (OCC Definition)—Other Assets Especially Mentioned (OAEM) are loans that are currently protected but are potentially weak. Loans with special mention ratings have potential weaknesses which may, if not checked or corrected, weaken the asset or inadequately protect the bank’s credit position at some future date. Such assets constitute an undue and unwarranted credit risk but not to the point of justifying a classification of substandard. The credit risk may be relatively minor yet constitute an unwarranted risk in light of the circumstances surrounding a specific asset.
•  Risk Rating 7/Substandard (OCC Definition)—These loans are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any. Assets so classified must have a well-defined weakness that jeopardizes the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected. Loss potential, while existing in the aggregate amount of substandard assets, does not have to exist in individual assets classified as substandard.
•  Risk Rating 8/Doubtful (OCC Definition)—These loans have all the weakness inherent in one classified as substandard with the added characteristics that the weakness makes collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable. The possibility of loss is extremely high, but because of certain important and reasonably specific pending factors which may work to the advantage and strengthening of the asset, its classification as an estimated loss is deferred until its more exact status may be determined. Pending factors include proposed merger, acquisition, or liquidating procedures, capital injection, perfecting liens or additional collateral and refinancing plans.
 
 
PAGE 82

 

•  Risk Rating 9/Loss (OCC Definition)—These loans are classified as Loss and charged-off because they are determined to be uncollectible and unbankable assets. This classification does not mean that the asset has absolutely no recovery or salvage value, but rather it is not practical or desirable to defer writing off this basically worthless asset even though partial recovery may be effected in the future. The bank should not be allowed to attempt long-term recoveries while the asset remains booked. Losses should be taken in the period in which they are determined to be uncollectible.
 
The following table presents weighted average risk grades and classified loans by type of loans as of December 31, 2012 and 2011. Classified loans include loans in Risk Grades 6, 7 and 8.
 
 
2012
   
2011
 
   
Weighted Average Risk Grade
   
Loans
   
Weighted Average Risk Grade
   
Loans
 
Commercial and industrial
                       
 Risk grades 1–4
    3.21     $ 614,620       3.41     $ 603,375  
 Risk grade 5
    5.00       3,823       5.00       5,006  
 Risk grade 6
    6.00             6.00       11,872  
 Risk grade 7
    7.00       9,342       7.00       3,871  
 Risk grade 8
                       
 Risk grade 9
                       
  Total
    3.28     $ 627,785       3.50     $ 624,124  
Loans to nondepository institutions
                               
 Risk grades 1–4
    3.13     $ 342,020       3.14     $ 240,154  
 Risk grade 5
    5.00       5,933              
 Risk grade 6
    6.00       856              
 Risk grade 7
                7.00       6,433  
 Risk grade 8
                       
 Risk grade 9
                       
  Total
    3.17     $ 348,809       3.24     $ 246,587  
Factored receivables
                               
 Risk grades 1–4
    3.08     $ 146,371       2.84     $ 170,256  
 Risk grade 5
    5.00       4,751       5.00       1,575  
 Risk grade 6
    6.00       471              
 Risk grade 7
                       
 Risk grade 8
                       
 Risk grade 9
                       
  Total
    3.13     $ 151,593       2.86     $ 171,831  
Equipment financing receivables
                               
 Risk grades 1–4
    3.93     $ 161,755       3.89     $ 150,412  
 Risk grade 5
                       
 Risk grade 6
                       
 Risk grade 7
    7.00       339       7.00       370  
 Risk grade 8
                       
 Risk grade 9
                       
  Total
    3.94     $ 162,094       3.90     $ 150,782  
 
 
PAGE 83

 
 
 
   
2012
     2011  
    Weighted Average Risk Grade    
Loans
   
Weighted Average Risk Grade
   
Loans
 
Real estate—commercial mortgage & construction and land development
                               
 Risk grades 1–4
    3.07     $ 186,582       3.18     $ 87,805  
 Risk grade 5
                       
 Risk grade 6
    6.00       8,685       6.00       8,517  
 Risk grade 7
    7.00       745       7.00       3,124  
 Risk grade 8
                       
 Risk grade 9
                       
  Total
    3.21     $ 196,012       3.54     $ 99,446  
 
Allowance for Loan Losses
The allowance reflects management’s best estimate of probable losses within the existing loan portfolio and of the risk inherent in various components of the loan portfolio. The allowance, in the judgment of management, is necessary to reserve for estimated loan losses and risk inherent in the loan portfolio. Additions to the allowance for loan losses are made by charges to the provision for loan losses. Credit exposures deemed to be uncollectible are charged against the allowance for loan losses. Recoveries of previously charged off amounts are credited to the allowance for loan losses.
 
The Company’s allowance for loan loss methodology is based on guidance provided by the “Interagency Policy Statement on the Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses” issued by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the National Credit Union Administration and the Office of Thrift Supervision in December 2006 and includes an allowance allocation calculated in accordance with U.S. GAAP guidance in FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables and allowance allocations calculated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450: Contingencies. Accordingly, the methodology is based on historical loss experience by type of credit and internal risk grade, specific homogeneous risk pools and specific loss allocations, with adjustments for current events and conditions.
 
The level of the allowance for loan losses relies on a consistent process that requires multiple layers of management review and judgment and of industry concentrations, specific credit risks, loan loss experience, current loan portfolio quality, present economic, political and regulatory conditions and unidentified losses inherent in the current loan portfolio. Portions of the allowance may be allocated to specific credits; however, the entire allowance is available for any credit that, in management’s judgment, should be charged off. While management utilizes its best judgment and information available, the ultimate adequacy of the allowance is dependent upon a variety of factors beyond the Company’s control, including, among other things, the performance of the Company’s loan portfolio, the economy, changes in interest rates and the view of the regulatory authorities toward loan classifications.
 
The Company’s allowance for loan losses includes (1) specific valuation allowances for impaired loans evaluated in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 310: Receivables; (2) formulaic allowances based on historical loss experience by loan category, adjusted, as necessary, to reflect the impact of current conditions; and (3) unallocated general valuation allowances determined in accordance with FASB Codification Topic 450: Contingencies based on general economic conditions and other qualitative risk factors both internal and external to the Company.
 
The allowance established for losses on specific loans is based on a regular analysis and evaluation of problem loans. Loans are classified based on an internal credit risk grading process that evaluates, among other things: (i) the obligor’s ability to repay; (ii) the underlying collateral, if any; and (iii) the economic environment and industry in which the borrower operates. This analysis is performed at the relationship manager level for all loans. When a loan has a calculated grade of 6 or higher, an analysis is performed to determine whether the loan is impaired and, if impaired, the need to specifically allocate a portion of the allowance for loan losses to the loan. Specific valuation allowances are determined by analyzing the borrower’s ability to repay amounts owed, collateral deficiencies, the relative risk grade of the loan and economic conditions affecting the borrower’s industry, among other things.
 
 
PAGE 84

 
 
Historical valuation allowances are calculated based on the historical loss experience of specific types of loans and the internal risk grade of such loans at the time they were charged-off. The Company calculates historical loss ratios for pools of similar loans with similar characteristics based on the portion of actual charge-offs experienced to the total population of loans in the pool. The historical loss ratios are periodically updated based on actual charge-off experience. A historical valuation allowance is established for each pool of similar loans based upon the product of the historical loss ratio and the total dollar amount of the loans in the pool. During 2010 the Company revised its historical loss ratio calculation to reflect a five year history from a ten year history to reflect the recent loss experience.
 
The Company’s pool of similar loans includes similarly risk-graded groups of commercial and industrial loans, com­mercial real estate loans, residential real estate loans and consumer and other loans.
 
General valuation allowances are based on general economic conditions and other qualitative risk factors both internal and external to the Company. In general, such valuation allowances are determined by evaluating, among other things:
•  Estimated losses in all significant loans
•  Existence and effect of any concentrations of credit
•  Existence and effect of any geographic concentration
•  Other external factors such as competition, legal matters or regulation that may affect risk
•  Effect of criticized and classified loans
•  Effects from risk arising with international lending
•  Effectiveness of internal problem loan identification and risk ratings
•  Trends in portfolio volume, maturity and compositions of loans within segments
•  Volumes and trends in delinquencies and nonaccrual loans
•  Changes in the quality of lending policies and procedures
•  Changes in local and national economic conditions
•  Experience, ability and depth of lending staff
•  Changes in value of underlying collateral
 
Management evaluates the degree of risk that each one of these components has on the quality of the loan portfolio on a quarterly basis. Each component is determined based on degree of risk. The results are then input into a “general allocation matrix” to determine an appropriate general valuation allowance.
 
Included in the general valuation allowances are allocations for groups of similar loans with risk characteristics that exceed certain concentration limits established by management. Concentration risk limits have been established, among other things, for certain industry concentrations, large and highly leveraged credit relationships that exceed specified risk grades, and loans originated with policy exceptions that exceed specified risk grades.
 
Loans are generally charged-off at the earlier of the date when it is determined that collection efforts are no longer productive or the date when they have been identified as losses by management, internal loan review and/or bank examiners. Furthermore, equipment financing receivables and revolving credit lines to small businesses are charged-off at the earlier of the date when payments are 120 days past due or when it is determined that collection efforts are no longer productive.
 
Factors considered in determining whether collection efforts are no longer productive include any amounts currently being collected, the status of discussions or negotiations with the lessee/borrower, the principal and/or guarantors, the cost of continuing efforts to collect, the status of any foreclosure or other legal actions, the value of the collateral, and any other pertinent factors.
 
 
PAGE 85

 
 
The following table presents the activity in the allowance for loan losses by portfolio segment:
 
Year Ended December 31, 2012
 
Balance, Beginning of Period
   
Charge-Offs
   
Recoveries
   
Net Charge-Offs
   
Provision for Loan Losses
   
Balance, End of Period
 
Commercial and industrial   $ 7,647     $ 4,993     $ 267     $ 4,726     $ 5,741     $ 8,662  
Loans to nondepository institutions
    1,369                         357       1,726  
Factored receivables
    1,450       387       102       285       282       1,447  
Equipment financing receivables
    3,515       2,602       1,282       1,320       1,568       3,763  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    3,490       825 (1)     8       817 (1)     1,091       3,764  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    2,151       671       66       605       958       2,504  
Real estate—construction and land development
    165                         (9 )     156  
Loans to individuals
    104       194       15       179       238       163  
Loans to depository institutions
                                   
Unallocated
    138                         24       162  
 Total
  $ 20,029     $  9,672 (1)   $ 1,740     $  7,932 (1)   $ 10,250     $ 22,347  
Year Ended December 31, 2011
                                               
Commercial and industrial   $ 7,454     $ 2,909     $ 146     $ 2,763     $ 2,956     $ 7,647  
Loans to nondepository institutions
    564                         805       1,369  
Factored receivables
    1,424       358       79       279       305       1,450  
Equipment financing receivables
    3,423       8,266       2,255       6,011       6,103       3,515  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    2,497       1,291 (1)     165       1,126 (1)     2,119       3,490  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    2,275                         (124 )     2,151  
Real estate—construction and land development
    310                         (145 )     165  
Loans to individuals
    119       30             30       15       104  
Loans to depository institutions
    46                         (46 )      
Unallocated
    126                         12       138  
 Total
  $ 18,238     $ 12,854 (1)   $ 2,645     $ 10,209 (1)   $ 12,000     $ 20,029  
[1] Includes losses on transfers to OREO
 
The following table presents the activity in the allowance for the period shown:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2010
 
Allowance for loan losses:
     
Balance at beginning of year
  $ 19,872  
Charge-offs:
       
Commercial and industrial
    7,212  
Factored receivables
    665  
Equipment financing receivables
    22,509  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    351  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    129  
Real estate—construction and land development
     
Loans to individuals
    231  
Total charge-offs
    31,097  
Recoveries:
       
Commercial and industrial
    312  
Factored receivables
    239  
Equipment financing receivables
    902  
Real estate—residential mortgage
     
Real estate—commercial mortgage
     
Real estate—construction and land development
     
Loans to individuals
    48  
Total recoveries
    1,501  
Subtract:
       
Net charge-offs
    29,596  
Provision for loan losses
    28,500  
Less loss on transfers to other real estate owned
    538  
Balance at end of year
  $ 18,238  
 
 
PAGE 86

 
 
The following tables present the balance in the allowance for loan losses and the recorded investment in loans by portfolio segment and based on impairment method for the periods indicated:
 
   
Ending Allowance Balance
   
Loan Balances
 
   
Attributable to Loans Evaluated for Impairment
         
Evaluated for Impairment
       
Year Ended December 31, 2012
 
Individually
   
Collectively
   
Total
   
Individually
   
Collectively
   
Total
 
Commercial and industrial
  $ 325     $ 8,337     $ 8,662     $ 2,406     $ 625,379     $ 627,785  
Loans to nondepository institutions
          1,726       1,726             348,809       348,809  
Factored receivables
          1,447       1,447             151,593       151,593  
Equipment financing receivables
    7       3,756       3,763       89       162,005       162,094  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    1,592       2,172       3,764       6,152       145,457       151,609  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    350       2,154       2,504       745       181,990       182,735  
Real estate—construction and land development
          156       156             13,277       13,277  
Loans to individuals
          163       163             11,851       11,851  
Loans to depository institutions
                                   
Unallocated
                162                    
 Total
  $ 2,274     $ 19,911     $ 22,347     $ 9,392     $ 1,640,361     $ 1,649,753  
                                                 
Year Ended December 31, 2011
                                               
Commercial and industrial
  $ 287     $ 7,360     $ 7,647     $ 2,954     $ 621,170     $ 624,124  
Loans to nondepository institutions
          1,369       1,369             246,587       246,587  
Factored receivables
          1,450       1,450             171,831       171,831  
Equipment financing receivables
    17       3,498       3,515       151       150,631       150,782  
Real estate—residential mortgage
    1,234       2,256       3,490       5,275       164,878       170,153  
Real estate—commercial mortgage
    1,113       1,038       2,151       3,124       82,701       85,825  
Real estate—construction and land development
          165       165             13,621       13,621  
Loans to individuals
          104       104             10,376       10,376  
Loans to depository institutions
                            10       10  
Unallocated
                138                    
 Total
  $ 2,651     $ 17,240     $ 20,029     $ 11,504     $ 1,461,805     $ 1,473,309  

NOTE 6.
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
 
The following table presents information on premises and equipment:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Land and building
  $ 346     $ 344  
Furniture and equipment
    12,245       15,221  
Leasehold improvements
    25,334       24,139  
      37,925       39,704  
Accumulated amortization and depreciation
    15,347       16,079  
Premises and equipment, net
  $ 22,578     $ 23,625  

 
PAGE 87

 
 
NOTE 7.
INTEREST-BEARING DEPOSITS
 
The following table presents certain information for interest expense on deposits:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Interest expense
                 
Interest-bearing deposits in domestic offices
                 
Savings
  $ 4     $ 8     $ 11  
NOW
    258       372       472  
Money Market
    2,324       2,475       2,805  
Time
                       
Three months or less
    1,387       2,185       2,665  
More than three months through twelve months
    2,252       1,776       3,086  
More than twelve months through twenty-four months
    357       1,215       270  
More than twenty-four months through thirty-six months
    141       235       212  
More than thirty-six months through forty-eight months
    6       142       23  
More than forty-eight months through sixty months
    7       29       41  
More than sixty months
    1       1        
      6,737       8,438       9,585  
Interest-bearing deposits in foreign offices
                       
Time
                       
Three months or less
                3  
More than three months through twelve months
                 
Total
  $ 6,737     $ 8,438     $ 9,588  
 
The aggregate of time certificates of deposit and other time deposits in denominations of $100 thousand or more was $547.6 million and $541.8 million at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively.
 
The following table provides certain information with respect to the Company’s deposits at the end of the two most recent fiscal years; there were no foreign deposits at either date:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Domestic
           
Demand
  $ 924,351     $ 765,800  
NOW
    199,934       177,495  
Savings
    24,886       18,566  
Money Market
    476,872       369,362  
Time deposits by remaining maturity:
               
Three months or less
    184,714       249,245  
More than three months through six months
    206,452       228,209  
More than six months through twelve months
    151,386       130,988  
More than twelve months through twenty-four months
    78,307       23,307  
More than twenty-four months through thirty-six months
    19,729       25,054  
More than thirty-six months through forty-eight months
    185       1,045  
More than forty-eight months through sixty months
    1,204        
More than sixty months
    64        
Total
  $ 2,268,084     $ 1,989,071  
 
The Company began participating in the Certificate of Deposit Account Registry Service (“CDARS”) on January 22, 2009.  CDARS deposits totaled approximately $100.9 million and $164.5 million at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011, respectively.
 
 
PAGE 88

 

NOTE 8.
SHORT-TERM BORROWINGS
 
The following table presents information regarding short-term borrowings:
 
Years Ended December 31,
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
Federal funds purchased
                       
At December 31 — Balance
  $  
    $  
    $  
15,000
 
—Weighted average interest rate
                      0.15%  
—Weighted average original maturity (Days)
                     
1
 
During the year — Maximum month-end balance
      30,000         60,000         105,000  
—Daily average balance
      10,093         10,926         33,192  
—Weighted average interest rate paid
      0.22%         0.13%         0.22%  
—Range of interest rates paid
    0.12 0.31%     0.07 0.25%     0.10 0.35%
Commercial paper
                             
At December 31 — Balance
  $  
15,345
    $  
13,485
    $  
14,388
 
—Weighted average interest rate
      0.32%         0.29%         0.29%  
—Weighted average original maturity (Days)
     
35
       
44
       
45
 
During the year — Maximum month-end balance
      19,345         16,573         16,927  
—Daily average balance
      14,826         14,454         14,718  
—Weighted average interest rate paid
      0.29%         0.30 %         0.30%  
—Range of interest rates paid
    0.25 0.60%     0.20 0.60%     0.20 0.65%
Short-term borrowings—FRB
                             
At December 31 — Balance
  $  
    $  
    $  
 
— Weighted average interest rate
                       
— Weighted average original maturity
                       
During the year — Maximum month-end balance
                      25,000  
— Daily average balance
                      3,699  
— Weighted average interest rate paid
                      0.25%  
— Range of interest rates paid
                      0.25%  
Short-term borrowings—treasury tax and loan and term Federal funds purchased
                             
At December 31 — Balance
  $  
    $  
    $  
3,490
 
— Weighted average interest rate
                       
— Weighted average original maturity (Days)
                     
1
 
During the year — Maximum month-end balance
              23,864         46,779  
— Daily average balance
              3,666         7,306  
— Weighted average interest rate paid
              0.07 %         0.25%  
— Range of interest rates paid
            0.00 0.31%     0.00 0.40%
 
Commercial paper is issued by the parent company and is not guaranteed by any subsidiary. The parent company has agreements with banks for back-up lines of credit for which it pays a fee at the annual rate of ¼ of 1% times the line of credit extended. At December 31, 2012, these back-up bank lines of credit totaled $14 million; no lines were used at any time during 2012, 2011 or 2010.
 
 
PAGE 89

 
 
NOTE 9.
SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE
 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are secured by obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises and corporate debt obligations with a carrying amount of $46.4 million and $68.3 million at December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively.
 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are financing arrangements that mature within two years. At maturity, the securities underlying the agreements are returned to the Company. Information concerning securities sold under agreements to repurchase is summarized as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—customers
                       
At December 31 — Balance
  $  
32,950
    $  
47,313
    $  
23,016
 
—Weighted average interest rate
      0.36%         0.34%         0.45%  
—Weighted average original maturity (Days)
      23         21         35  
During the year — Maximum month-end balance
      43,199         51,991         55,998  
—Daily average balance
      39,318         42,911         47,674  
—Weighted average interest rate paid
      0.36 %         0.43%         0.48%  
—Range of interest rates paid
    0.25 0.55     0.25 0.65%     0.35 0.65%
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase—dealers
                             
At December 31 —Balance
  $  
    $  
5,000
    $  
5,000
 
—Weighted average interest rate
              1.30%         1.30%  
—Weighted average original maturity (Days)
              731         731  
During the year —Maximum month-end balance
      5,000         5,000        
39,893
 
—Daily average balance
      2,637         5,186         5,618  
—Weighted average interest rate paid
      1.18%         1.27%         0.79%  
—Range of interest rates paid
    0.25 1.30%     0.13 1.30%     0.25 1.30%
 
NOTE 10.
ADVANCES—FHLB AND LONG-TERM BORROWINGS
 
These borrowings represent advances from the FHLB and junior subordinated debt securities issued by the parent company.
 
The following table presents information regarding fixed and floating rate FHLB advances:
 
Advance
 
Interest
 
Maturity
 
December 31,
 
Type
 
Rate
 
Date
 
2012
   
2011
 
Fixed Rate
                   
 Term
    0.53  
8/6/12
  $     $ 10,000  
 Term
    2.26  
7/16/12
          10,000  
 Term
    1.73  
4/12/13
    355       1,197  
 Term
    2.13  
4/14/14
    910       1,536  
Floating Rate
                         
 Term
    0.73  
2/10/16
    50,000       50,000  
 Term
    0.73  
2/10/16
    50,000       50,000  
 Total
            $ 101,265     $ 122,733  
 Weighted-average interest rate
              0.75 %     0.97 %
 
 
PAGE 90

 
 
During the 2011 first quarter, the bank restructured a portion of its FHLB fixed rate callable and term advances by repaying $100 million of existing borrowings and replacing them with $100 million of lower cost, floating rate advances. This transaction resulted in $4.2 million in prepayment penalties that were deferred and will be recognized in interest expense as an adjustment to the cost of these borrowings in future periods. The existing borrowings had an average cost of 2.58% and an average duration of 3.2 years. The new borrowings had an initial average cost of 1.58%, including the deferred adjustment, with an average duration of three months. The relevant accounting treatment for this transaction was provided in ASC 470-50. This transaction was executed as an earnings and interest rate risk strategy, resulting in lower FHLB advance costs and a reduction of average duration.
 
Under the terms of a collateral agreement with the FHLB, advances are secured by stock in the FHLB and by certain qualifying assets (primarily mortgage-backed securities) having market values at least equal to 110% of the advances outstanding.
 
In February 2002, the Company completed its issuance of trust capital securities (“capital securities”) that raised $25 million ($24.1 million net proceeds after issuance costs). The 8.375% capital securities, due March 31, 2032, were issued by Sterling Bancorp Trust I (the “trust”), a wholly-owned non-consolidated statutory business trust. The trust was formed with initial capitalization of common stock and for the exclusive purpose of issuing the capital securities. The trust used the proceeds from the issuance of the capital securities to acquire $25.8 million junior subordinated debt securities that pay interest at 8.375% (“debt securities”) issued by the parent company. The Company is not considered the primary beneficiary of the trust (which is a VIE); therefore the trust is not consolidated in the Company’s financial statements, but rather the subordinated debentures are shown as a liability. The debt securities are due concurrently with the capital securities, which may not be redeemed, except under limited circumstances, until March 31, 2007, and thereafter at a price equal to their principal amount plus interest accrued to the date of redemption. The Company may also reduce outstanding capital securities, through open market purchases. During 2012, 2011 and 2010, the parent company did not purchase any capital securities. Securities purchased are included in the Company’s securities available for sale and are considered to be outstanding for the payment of dividends but are considered to be redeemed for the calculation of the regulatory capital ratios. During 2012, 2011 and 2010, the Company’s tax-qualified defined benefit pension plan (the “Plan”) did not purchase any capital securities. The amounts of capital securities held by third parties at December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010 were $22.8 million, $22.8 million and $22.8 million, respectively. Dividends and interest are paid quarterly.
 
The parent company has the right to defer payments of interest on the debt securities at any time or from time to time for a period of up to 20 consecutive quarterly periods with respect to each deferral period. Under the terms of the debt securities, in the event that under certain circumstances there is an event of default under the debt securities or the parent company has elected to defer interest on the debt securities, the parent company may not, with certain exceptions, declare or pay any dividends or distributions on its capital stock or purchase or acquire any of its capital stock.
 
Payments of distributions on the capital securities and payments on redemption of the capital securities are guaranteed by the parent company on a limited basis. The parent company also entered into an agreement as to expenses and liabilities pursuant to which it agreed, on a subordinated basis, to pay any costs, expenses or liabilities of the trust other than those arising under the capital securities. The obligations of the parent company under the debt securities, the related indenture, the trust agree­ment establishing the trust, the guarantee and the agreement as to expenses and liabilities, in the aggregate, constitute a full and unconditional guarantee by the parent company of the trust’s obligations under the capital securities.
 
The ability of the parent company to obtain funds from its subsidiaries is limited (see Note 15).
 
Notwithstanding that the accounts of the trust are not included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements, the amount of capital securities issued by the trust and held by third parties is included in the Tier 1 capital of the parent company for regulatory capital purposes as allowed by the Federal Reserve Board. In March 2005, the Federal Reserve Board adopted a rule that would continue to allow the inclusion of capital securities issued by unconsolidated subsidiary trusts in Tier 1 capital, but with stricter quantitative limits. Under the final rule, after March 31, 2011, the aggregate amount of capital securities and certain other capital elements is limited to 25% of Tier 1 capital, net of goodwill less any associated deferred tax liability. Based on the final rule, the parent company continues to include the amount of capital securities held by third parties in Tier 1 capital.
 
 
PAGE 91

 
 
NOTE 11.
PREFERRED SHARES
 
The parent company is authorized to issue up to 644,389 preferred shares, $5 par value per share, in one or more series. No preferred shares were issued and outstanding at December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011.
 
Under the provisions of the TARP Capital Purchase Program enacted under EESA, on December 23, 2008, the parent company sold to the U.S. Treasury 42,000 shares of the parent company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Shares, Series A, par value $5.00 per share, having a liquidation preference of $1 thousand per share (the “Series A Preferred Shares”), together with a warrant to purchase 516,817 shares of its common shares, for an aggregate price of $42 million.
 
On April 27, 2011, the parent company paid $42.4 million to the U.S. Treasury for the repurchase in full of the Series A Preferred Shares. As a result of this action, the Series A Preferred Shares were redeemed in full, eliminating an annual dividend of $2.1 million. In this connection, in determining net income available to common shareholders, the Company recognized in the second quarter a $1.2 million charge for accelerated accretion, which represents the difference between the carrying value and the liquidation value for the repurchased Series A Preferred Shares. On May 18, 2011, the parent company paid approximately $0.95 million to the U.S. Treasury to repurchase the warrant. The parent company’s repurchase of the warrant concluded its participation in the TARP Capital Purchase Program.
 
NOTE 12.
COMMON SHARES
 
On March 9, 2011, the Company completed an underwritten public offering of 4.025 million common shares at an offering price of $9.60 per share, which resulted in net proceeds of $36.5 million after underwriting discounts and expenses. On March 19, 2010, the Company completed an underwritten public offering of 8.625 million common shares at an offering price of $8.00 per share, which resulted in net proceeds of $64.9 million after underwriting discounts and expenses.
 
The following table provides information regarding the number of common shares issued:
 
   
Number of
Shares Issued
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Issued at beginning of year
    35,225,110       31,138,545  
Shares issued—acquisition
    38,658        
Shares issued—public offering
          4,025,000  
Shares issued under stock incentive plan
          61,565  
Issued at end of year
    35,263,768       35,225,110  
 
NOTE 13.
TREASURY SHARES
 
The following table provides information regarding the number of common shares held by the Company:
 
   
Number of
Shares Held
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Held at beginning of year
    4,300,278       4,297,782  
Surrender of shares issued under incentive compensation plan
    7,694       2,496  
Held at end of year
    4,307,972       4,300,278  
 
 
PAGE 92

 
 
NOTE 14.
ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
 
Information related to the components of accumulated other comprehensive loss is as follows with related tax effect:
 
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Other Comprehensive Loss
                 
 Unrealized holding gains on available for sale securities arising during the period:
                 
  Before tax
  $ 8,791     $ 428     $ 3,846  
  Tax effect
    (3,913 )     (184 )     (1,745 )
   Net of tax
    4,878       244       2,101  
 Reclassification adjustment for securities gains included in net income:
                       
  Before tax
    (1,813 )     (2,491 )     (3,928 )
  Tax effect
    807       1,109       1,783  
   Net of tax
    (1,006 )     (1,382 )     (2,145 )
 Pension liability adjustment—net actuarial losses:
                       
  Before tax
    (15,206 )     (3,315 )     (3,551 )
  Tax effect
    6,768       1,309       1,611  
   Net of tax
    (8,438 )     (2,006 )     (1,940 )
 Reclassification adjustment for amortization of prior service cost:
                       
  Before tax
    39       63       67  
  Tax effect
    (18 )     (28 )     (31 )
   Net of tax
    21       35       36  
 Reclassification adjustment for amortization of net actuarial losses:
                       
  Before tax
    4,090       3,208       2,673  
  Tax effect
    (1,820 )     (1,428 )     (1,213 )
   Net of tax
    2,270       1,780       1,460  
Other comprehensive loss
  $ (2,275 )   $ (1,329 )   $ (488 )
 
The following table presents the components of accumulated other comprehensive loss as of December 31, 2012 and 2011 included in shareholders’ equity:
 
   
Pre-tax
Amount
   
Tax
Effect
   
After-tax
Amount
 
December 31, 2012
                 
Net unrealized gain on securities
  $ 5,263     $ (2,349 )   $ 2,914  
Adjustment for underfunded pension and postretirement life insurance obligations
    (34,984 )     15,579       (19,405 )
Total
  $ (29,721 )   $ 13,230     $ (16,491 )
December 31, 2011
                       
Net unrealized loss on securities
  $ (1,720 )   $ 763     $ (957 )
Adjustment for underfunded pension and postretirement life insurance obligations
    (23,925 )     10,666       (13,259 )
Total
  $ (25,645 )   $ 11,429     $ (14,216 )

 
PAGE 93

 
 
NOTE 15.
RESTRICTIONS ON THE BANK
 
The parent company depends for its cash requirements on funds maintained or generated by its subsidiaries, principally the bank. Approval by the Comptroller of the Currency is required if the effect of dividends declared would cause the regulatory capital of the bank to fall below specified minimum levels. Additionally, all national banks are limited in the payment of dividends in any year without the approval of the Comptroller of the Currency to an amount not to exceed the net profits (as defined) for that year to date combined with its retained net profits for the preceding two calendar years. Under the foregoing restrictions, as of December 31, 2012 the bank could pay dividends of approximately $57.3 million to the parent company, without regulatory approval.
 
Federal law also prohibits national banks from paying dividends that would be greater than the bank’s undivided profits after deducting statutory bad debt in excess of the bank’s allowance for loan losses. Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”), a depository institution, such as the bank, may not pay dividends if payment would cause it to become undercapitalized or it is already undercapitalized. The payment of dividends by the parent company and the bank may also be affected or limited by other factors, such as the requirement to maintain adequate capital.
 
NOTE 16.
STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN
 
In April 1992, shareholders approved a Stock Incentive Plan (the “SIP”) covering up to 100,000 common shares of the parent company. The SIP expired during 2012. Under the SIP, key employees of the parent company and its subsidiaries could be granted awards in the form of incentive stock options (“ISOs”), nonqualified stock options (“NQSOs”), stock appreciation rights (“SARs”), restricted stock or a combination of these. The SIP was administered by a committee of the Board of Directors.
 
The SIP provides for proportional adjustment to the number of shares covered by the SIP and by outstanding awards, and in the exercise price of outstanding stock options, to reflect, among other things, stock splits and stock dividends. The Company issued new shares to satisfy stock option exercises. The total intrinsic value of stock options exercised for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010 was $-0- thousand, $-0- thousand and $171 thousand, respectively.
 
 
PAGE 94

 

 
Stock Options
The following tables present information on the qualified and nonqualified stock options outstanding (after the effect of the stock dividends/splits discussed above) as of December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010 and changes during the years then ended:

   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Qualified Stock Options
 
Number of
Options
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price
   
Number of 
Options
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price
   
Number of
Options
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price
 
Outstanding at beginning of year
    144,121     $ 14.60       150,358     $ 14.43       204,112     $ 12.46  
Exercised
                            (53,754 )     6.94  
Forfeited/Lapsed
    (144,121 )     14.60       (6,237 )     10.61              
Outstanding at end of year
                144,121       14.60       150,358       14.43  
Options exercisable at end of year
                  144,121               143,502          
 
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Nonqualified Stock Options
 
Number of
Options
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price
   
Number of
Options
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price
   
Number of
Options
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price
 
Outstanding at beginning of year
    166,339     $ 16.54       272,389     $ 19.55       460,102     $ 15.49  
Exercised
                            (149,638 )     6.94  
Forfeited/Lapsed
    (78,839 )     14.92       (106,050 )     24.29       (38,075 )     20.03  
Outstanding at end of year
    87,500       17.99       166,339       16.54       272,389       19.55  
Options exercisable at end of year
    87,500               71,339               177,389          
 
At December 31, 2012, no qualified or NQSO stock options were outstanding, exercisable and in-the-money.
 
The following table presents information regarding nonqualified stock options outstanding at December 31, 2012:
 
   
Options Outstanding
   
Options Exercisable
 
   
Range of
Exercise
Prices
   
Number Outstanding
at 12/31/12
   
Weighted-Average
Remaining
Contractual Life (years)
   
Weighted-Average
Exercise
Price
   
Number Exercisable
at 12/31/12
   
Weighted-Average
Exercise
Price
 
Nonqualified
  $ 17.99       87,500       4.20     $ 17.99       87,500     $ 17.99  
 
Director NQSOs expire five years from the date of the grant and become exercisable in four annual installments, starting one year from the date of the grant, or upon the earlier of death or disability of the grantee. Employee stock options generally expire ten years from the date of the grant and vest one year from the date of grant, although, if necessary to qualify to the maximum extent possible as ISOs, these options become exercisable in annual installments. Employee stock options, which become exercisable over a period of more than one year, are generally subject to earlier exercisability upon the termination of the grantee’s employment for any reason from the first anniversary of the grant date. Amounts received upon exercise of options are recorded as common shares and capital surplus. The additional tax benefit received by the Company upon exercise of a NQSO is credited to capital surplus.
 
 
PAGE 95

 
 
There were no options granted during 2012, 2011 or 2010.
 
Under the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 718: Com­pensation—Stock Compensation, the Company recorded compensation expense of $18 thousand, $85 thousand and $109 thousand during the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively, for option awards in 2006 and 2007. As of December 31, 2012, the total remaining unrecognized compensation cost related to option awards was $-0- thousand.
 
The tax benefit recognized as a credit to capital surplus upon the exercise of NQSOs amounted to approximately $-0- thousand at December 31, 2012, $-0- thousand at December 31, 2011 and $66 thousand at December 31, 2010.
 
Restricted Stock
On March 25, 2010, the Board of Directors, upon recommendation by the Compensation and Corporate Governance Committees, granted a total of 40,000 shares of restricted stock to the eight non-management directors (“2010 director restricted shares”) and 43,728 restricted shares to the Chairman, President, and five Executive Vice Presidents (“2010 officer restricted shares”). The 2010 director restricted shares will vest 25% annually over four years beginning on the first anniversary of the grant date. The 2010 officer restricted shares vest 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date and 25% on each of the third and fourth anniversaries of the grant date and are also limited by the 2008 agreement between the Company and the U.S. Treasury. The 2010 director restricted shares and the 2010 officer restricted shares were issued at $9.23 per share, the closing price on the date of the grant. The agreements for both the 2010 director restricted shares and the 2010 officer restricted shares have additional provisions regarding transferability and accelerated vesting of the shares and the continuation of performing substantial services for the Company. As of December 31, 2012, all 83,728 shares were still issued and 20,000 of the 2010 director restricted shares and 21,864 of the 2010 officer restricted shares were vested.
 
On March 24, 2011, the Board of Directors, upon recommendation by the Compensation and Corporate Governance Committees, granted a total of 20,000 shares of restricted stock to the eight non-management directors (“2011 director restricted shares”) and 41,565 restricted shares to the Chairman, President and five Executive Vice Presidents (“2011 officer restricted shares”). The 2011 director restricted shares will vest 25% annually over four years beginning on the first anniversary of the grant date. The 2011 officer restricted shares vest 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date and 25% on each of the third and fourth anniversaries of the grant date and had been limited by the 2008 agreement between the Company and the U.S. Treasury until the Preferred Shares were redeemed on April 27, 2011. The 2011 director restricted shares and the 2011 officer restricted shares were issued at $9.71 per share, the closing price on the date of the grant. The agreements for both the 2011 director restricted shares and the 2011 officer restricted shares have additional provisions regarding transferability and accelerated vesting of the shares and the continuation of performing substantial services for the Company. As of December 31, 2012, all 61,565 shares were still issued and 5,000 of the 2011 director restricted shares were vested.
 
Under the provisions of FASB Codification Topic 718: Compensation—Stock Compensation, the Company recorded compensation expense of $342 thousand during the year ended December 31, 2012 and a related tax benefit of $153 thousand. As of December 31, 2012, the total remaining unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted stock awards was $571 thousand, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average vesting period of 1.8 years.
 
NOTE 17.
EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
 
Retirement Plans
The Company has a noncontributory, tax-qualified defined benefit pension plan (the “DBP”) that covers the majority of employees with one or more years of service of at least 1,000 hours, who are at least 21 years of age. The benefits are based upon years of credited service, primary social security benefits and a participant’s highest average compensation as defined in the DBP. The funding requirements for the plan are determined annually based upon the amount needed to satisfy the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 funding standards. No employees initially hired after January 2, 2006 were eligible to enter the plan.
 
The Company also has a noncontributory, supplemental non-qualified, non-funded retirement plan which is designed to supplement the pension plan for key officers.
 
 
PAGE 96

 

The following tables, using a December 31 measurement date for each period presented, set forth the disclosures required for pension benefits:
 
At or for the Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
CHANGE IN BENEFIT OBLIGATION
           
Benefit obligation at beginning of year (Projected Benefit Obligation)
  $ 77,011     $ 70,970  
Service cost
    2,481       2,147  
Interest cost
    4,129       3,933  
Actuarial loss
    13,352       1,890  
Benefits paid
    (2,203 )     (1,929 )
Benefit obligation at end of year
  $ 94,770     $ 77,011  
CHANGE IN PLAN ASSETS
               
Fair value of assets at beginning of year
  $ 43,299     $ 41,521  
Actual return on plan assets
    4,766       1,672  
Employer contributions
    9,034       2,035  
Benefits paid
    (2,203 )     (1,929 )
Fair value of assets at end of year
  $ 54,896     $ 43,299  
Funded status
  $ (39,874 )   $ (33,712 )
AMOUNTS RECOGNIZED IN THE CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS CONSIST OF:
               
Pension liability
  $ (39,874 )   $ (33,712 )
Accumulated other comprehensive loss (pre-tax)
    32,486       23,889  

   
Discount Rate
   
Rate of
Compen­sation Increase
 
   
2012
   
2011
   
2012
   
2011
 
WEIGHTED-AVERAGE ASSUMPTIONS USED TO DETERMINE THE BENEFIT OBLIGATION:
                       
Defined benefit pension plan
    4.10 %     5.10 %     3.00 %     3.00 %
Supplemental retirement plan
    4.10       5.10       3.00       3.00  
 
Components of the net periodic benefit expense and other amounts recognized in other comprehensive loss are as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
COMPONENTS OF NET PERIODIC COST
                 
Service cost
  $ 2,481     $ 2,147     $ 2,050  
Interest cost
    4,129       3,933       3,766  
Expected return on plan assets
    (3,976 )     (3,305 )     (3,020 )
Amortization of prior service cost
    39       63       67  
Recognized actuarial loss
    3,926       3,159       2,672  
Net periodic benefit expense
    6,599       5,997       5,535  
Other changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in other comprehensive loss:
                       
  Net actuarial loss, after tax
    6,168       226       480  
  Prior service credit, after tax
    (21 )     (35 )     (36 )
   Total recognized in other comprehensive loss
    6,147       191       444  
Total recognized in net periodic benefit expense and other comprehensive loss
  $ 12,746     $ 6,188     $ 5,979  
 
 
PAGE 97

 

   
Discount Rate
   
Expected Return
on Plan Assets
   
Rate of Compensation Increase
 
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
   
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
WEIGHTED-AVERAGE ASSUMPTIONS USED TO DETERMINE NET PERIODIC COST:
                                                     
Defined benefit pension plan
    5.10 %     5.50 %     6.00 %     8.00 %     8.00 %     8.00 %     3.00 %     3.00 %     3.00 %
Supplemental retirement plan
    5.10       5.50       6.00       N/A       N/A       N/A       3.00       3.00       3.00  
 
To determine the expected return on plan assets, we consider historical return information on plan assets, the mix of investments that comprise plan assets and the actual income derived from plan assets.
 
The accumulated benefit obligation for the defined benefit pension plan at December 31, 2012 and 2011 was $53.5 million and $45.5 million, respectively.
 
The tables presented on the previous page and above include the supplemental retirement plan, which is an unfunded plan. The following information is presented regarding the supplemental retirement plan:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Projected benefit obligation
  $ 36,546     $ 28,581  
Accumulated benefit obligation
    36,139       28,521  
 
The following table sets forth information regarding the assets of the defined benefit pension plan:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
U.S. government corporation and agency debt obligations
    3 %     3 %
Corporate debt obligations
    24       32  
Common equity securities
    63       59  
Other
    10       6  
Total
    100 %     100 %
 
The overall investment strategy of the Plan is to have a diversified portfolio of investments that balance risk and return with the goal of meeting or exceeding the plan’s actuarial return assumptions and shorter term liquidity needs. The asset mix can vary but, to achieve these objectives, it is targeted at 60% equity securities, including up to 10% in the parent company common shares, 25% in corporate obligations and 10% in federal and agency obligations with the balance in other investments including trust preferred securities. The allocation of Plan assets as of December 31, 2012 is shown in the table above. The money market investment positions will vary but, will generally be under 5%. The Plan’s asset allocation and investments are recommended and managed by an independent advisor.
 
The weighted average expected long-term rate of return is estimated based on current trends in the plan assets as well as projected future rates of returns on those assets. The long-term rate of return considers historical returns, with adjustments to reflect expectations of future returns as determined by the trustee’s investment advisor after consultation with the trustee. These adjustments include consideration of projected future economic conditions, interest rates, industry trends and other factors.
 
The defined benefit pension plan owns common shares of the parent company which is included in common equity securities above. At December 31, 2012, the fair value of the parent company common shares was $629 thousand and represented approximately 1% of plan assets. At December 31, 2011, the fair value of the parent company common shares was $597 thousand and represented approximately 1% of plan assets.
 
 
PAGE 98

 
 
The defined benefit pension plan also owns capital securities (see Note 10 for definition) issued by Sterling Bancorp Trust I, a wholly-owned non-consolidated statutory business trust (which is a VIE). At December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011, the fair value of the capital securities was $1.2 million and represented approximately 2% of plan assets at December 31, 2012 and 3% of plan assets at December 31, 2011.
 
The Company expects to contribute approximately $8.5 million to the defined benefit pension plan in 2013.
 
The following table presents benefit payments expected to be paid, based on the assumption described below, including the effect of expected future service for the years indicated.
 
Year(s)
 
Defined Benefit Plan
   
Supplemental Retirement Plan
   
Total
Benefit Payments
 
2013
  $
2,312
    $ 34,785     $ 37,097  
2014
    2,434       36       2,470  
2015
    2,579       1,005       3,584  
2016
    2,712       37       2,749  
2017
    2,941       38       2,979  
Years 2018–2022
    17,581       224       17,805  
 
The cash flows shown above are based on the assumptions used in the annual actuarial valuations of the defined benefit plan. The supplemental retirement plan column is computed assuming that any executive who has reached the age upon which full retirement is assumed for actuarial purposes actually retires in the current year. However, if such an executive does not actually retire in the current year, the obligation will be deferred until a later year. We are not aware of any senior executives who have near-term plans to retire.
 
Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss, pre-tax, as of December 31, 2012 and 2011 follow:
 
   
Qualified Pension Plan
   
Supplemental
Retirement Plan
   
Total
 
   
2012
   
2011
   
2012
   
2011
   
2012
   
2011
 
Net actuarial loss
  $ 22,556     $ 17,517     $ 9,927     $ 6,330     $ 32,483     $ 23,847  
Prior service cost
    15       38       (12 )     4       3       42  
Total
  $ 22,571     $ 17,555     $ 9,915     $ 6,334     $ 32,486     $ 23,889  
 
The estimated costs that will be amortized from accumulated other comprehensive loss into net periodic cost in 2013 are as follows:
 
   
Qualified Pension Plan
   
Supplemental
Retirement Plan
   
Total
 
Net actuarial loss
  $ 2,297     $ 1,798     $ 4,095  
Prior service cost
    4       (3 )     1  
Total
  $ 2,301     $ 1,795     $ 4,096  
 
Fair Value of Plan Assets: Fair value is the exchange price that would be received for an asset in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date.
 
 
PAGE 99

 
 
The Company used the following methods and significant assumptions to estimate the fair value of each type of financial instrument:
 
Equity, Debt, Investment Funds and Other Securities. The fair values for investment securities are determined by quoted market prices, if available (Level 1). For securities where quoted prices are not available, fair values are calculated based on market prices of similar securities (Level 2). For securities where quoted prices or market prices of similar securities are not available, fair values are calculated using discounted cash flows or other market indicators (Level 3). Discounted cash flows are calculated using spread to swap and LIBOR curves that are updated to incorporate loss severities, volatility, credit spread and optionality. During times when trading is more liquid, broker quotes are used (if available) to validate the model. Rating agency and industry research reports as well as defaults and deferrals on individual securities are reviewed and incorporated into the calculations.
 
The fair value of plan assets at December 31, 2012, by asset category, is as follows:
 
         
Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2012 Using:
 
   
Carrying Value
   
Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
   
Significant Other Observable Inputs
(Level 2)
   
  Significant Unobservable Inputs
(Level 3)
 
Plan Assets
                         
Equity securities
  $ 34,663     $ 34,663     $    
 —  
U.S. government agency obligations
    1,647       1,647            
 
Corporate debt securities
    13,197       13,197            
 —
 
Money market funds and other
    5,389             5,389      
 —
 
Total Plan Assets
  $ 54,896     $ 49,507     $ 5,389      
 
Savings Plans
As of January 1, 2008, the Company merged its two 401(k) plans into one plan (“new plan”). Eligible employees must complete 1,000 hours of service in order to be eligible for the Company matching contributions. Participants in the new plan eligible for Company matching contributions include any employee hired after January 1, 2006 and employees of two subsidiaries of the bank. Eligible employees may enroll in the new plan on the first day of the month after hire. The Company matches 25% of the eligible employee’s contribution to the plan based on the amount of each participant’s contributions, up to the Internal Revenue Service maximum contribution limit. All participants may immediately invest their individual contributions, as well as any Company matching contribution, in any of a variety of investment alternatives offered under the new plan. Expense for employer match related to the new plan totaled $304 thousand in 2012, $480 thousand in 2011 and $323 thousand in 2010.
 
Postretirement Life Insurance Benefits
The Company currently provides life insurance benefits to certain officers. The coverage provided depends upon years of service with the Company and the employee’s date of retirement. The Company’s plan for its postretirement benefit obligation is unfunded with a liability of $4.0 million at December 31, 2012 and $1.2 million at December 31, 2011. Net postretirement benefit cost was $349 thousand, $125 thousand and $65 thousand for 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Amounts related to the postretirement life insurance plan included in other comprehensive loss was a loss, net of taxes, of $1.4 million at December 31, 2012 and a gain, net of taxes, of $143 thousand at December 31, 2011.
 

 
PAGE 100

 
 
NOTE 18.
INCOME TAXES
 
The current and deferred tax provisions (benefits) applicable to income before taxes for each of the last three fiscal years are as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
FEDERAL
                 
Current
  $ 7,718     $ (71 )   $ 3,615  
Deferred
    (1,577 )     2,046       (1,734 )
Total
  $ 6,141     $ 1,975     $ 1,881  
STATE AND LOCAL
                       
Current
  $ 3,627     $ 2,188     $ 973  
Deferred
    (1,231 )     33       (696 )
Total
  $ 2,396     $ 2,221     $ 277  
TOTAL
                       
Current
  $ 11,345     $ 2,117     $ 4,588  
Deferred
    (2,808 )     2,079       (2,430 )
Total
  $ 8,537     $ 4,196     $ 2,158  
 
Reconciliations of income tax provisions with taxes computed at Federal statutory rates are as follows:
 
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Federal statutory rate
    35 %     35 %     34 %
Computed tax based on income from continuing operations
  $ 9,994     $ 7,627     $ 3,123  
Increase (Decrease) in tax resulting from:
                       
State and local taxes, net of Federal income tax benefit
    1,609       1,500       218  
Tax-exempt income
    (2,564 )     (2,578 )     (1,640 )
Tax benefit related to closed Federal tax audits
          (2,523 )      
Other permanent items
    (502 )     170       457  
Total
  $ 8,537     $ 4,196     $ 2,158  
 
 
PAGE 101

 
 
The components of the net deferred tax asset, included in other assets, are as follows:
 
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
Deferred tax assets
           
Difference between financial statement provision for loan losses and tax bad debt deduction
  $ 8,976     $ 7,909  
Pension and benefit plans
    15,579       10,649  
Available for sale securities
          763  
Compensation and other benefits
    4,243       1,934  
Deferred rent
    1,448       1,324  
Other
    1,316       1,127  
Total deferred tax assets
    31,562       23,706  
Deferred tax liabilities
               
Difference between tax and net book values of fixed assets
    2,273       2,029  
Available for sale securities
    2,349        
Other
    711       79  
Total deferred tax liabilities
    5,333       2,108  
Net deferred tax asset
  $ 26,229     $ 21,598  
 
Based on management’s consideration of historical and anticipated future pre-tax income, as well as the reversal period for the items giving rise to the deferred tax assets and liabilities, a valuation allowance for deferred assets was not considered necessary at December 31, 2012 and 2011 since it is more likely than not that these assets will be realized.
 
The current tax net payable as of December 31, 2012 was approximately $2.3 million. The current tax net receivable at December 31, 2011 was approximately $1.7 million.
 
At December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2011 the Company had accrued $715 thousand and $1.3 million, respectively, for taxes related to income tax audits and state income taxes due to changes in economic nexus rules governing taxation of business conducted within that state. The Company anticipates filing tax returns under the voluntary disclosure regulations of that state which will limit the Company's tax exposure to business conducted within that state during the past three years. The Company recognizes interest accrued related to unrecognized tax expense and penalties as income tax expense. At December 31, 2012 and 2011, the Consolidated Balance Sheet included accrued interest related to unrecognized tax expense of $150 thousand and $313 thousand, respectively. The Consolidated Statement of Income included a credit to interest expense of $163 thousand for 2012 and charges to interest expense of $16 thousand and $47 thousand for 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to U.S. federal income tax as well as income tax of multiple state jurisdictions. The Company’s federal income tax returns have been examined through 2009, with 2010 and 2011 subject to examination. The Company’s New York State tax returns have been closed through 2008 and 2009 through 2011 are subject to examination. The Company’s New York City tax returns are closed through 2008 and 2009 through 2011 are subject to examination.
 
NOTE 19.
EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE
 
Earnings per common share is computed using the two-class method. Basic earnings per common share is computed by dividing net earnings allocated to common shares by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the applicable period, excluding participating secu­rities. Participating securities include non-vested share awards such as awards of restricted common shares. Non-vested share awards are considered participating securities because holders of these securities receive non-forfeitable dividends at the same rate as holders of the Company’s common shares. Diluted earnings per common share is computed using the weighted-average number of shares determined for the basic earnings per common share computation plus the dilutive effect of stock option compensation using the treasury stock method.
 
 
PAGE 102

 
 
The following table presents the calculation of net earnings allocated to common shares and a reconciliation of the number of shares used in the calculation of basic and diluted earnings per common share:
 
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
Distributed earnings allocated to common shares
  $ 11,094     $ 11,055     $ 8,851  
Undistributed earnings allocated to common shares
    8,853       4,399       (4,429 )
Net earnings allocated to common shares
  $ 19,947     $ 15,454     $ 4,422  
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    30,828,293       30,038,047       24,492,279  
Add dilutive effect of:
                       
 Stock options
                2,765  
Adjusted for assumed diluted computation
    30,828,293       30,038,047       24,495,044  
 
Options issued with exercise prices greater than the average market price of the common shares for each of the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010 have not been included in computation of diluted earnings per share for those respective years. As of December 31, 2012, 87,500 options to purchase shares at $17.99 were not included; as of December 31, 2011, 310,460 options to purchase shares between $14.60 and $17.99 were not included; as of December 31, 2010, 422,747 options to purchase shares between $10.61 and $26.94 were not included.
 
NOTE 20.
FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
 
The fair value of an asset or liability is the price that would be receivable from selling that asset or payable to transfer that liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. A fair value measurement assumes that the transaction to sell the asset or transfer the liability occurs in the principal market for the asset or liability or, in the absence of a principal market, the most advantageous market for the asset or liability. The price in the principal (or most advantageous) market used to measure the fair value of the asset or liability shall not be adjusted for transaction costs. An orderly transaction is a transaction that assumes exposure to the market for a period prior to the measurement date to allow for marketing activities that are usual and customary for transactions involving such assets and liabilities; it is not a forced transaction. Market participants are buyers and sellers in the principal market that are independent, knowledgeable, able to transact and willing to transact.
 
FASB Codification Topic 820: Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures establishes a hierarchy for valuation inputs that gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair values hierarchy is as follows:
Level 1 InputsUnadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the reporting entity has the ability to access at the measurement date. Examples of financial instruments generally included in this level are U.S. Treasury securities, equity and trust preferred securities that trade in active markets and listed derivative instruments.
Level 2 InputsInputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. These might include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability (such as interest rates, volatilities, prepayment speeds, credit risks, etc.) or inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by market data by correlation or other means. Examples of financial instruments generally included in this level are corporate debt, mortgage-backed certificates issued by U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises, equity securities that trade in less active markets and certain derivative instruments.
Level 3 InputsUnobservable inputs for determining the fair values of assets or liabilities that reflect an entity’s own judgments about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the assets or liabilities. Examples of financial instruments generally included in this level are private equities, certain loans held for sale and other alternative investments.
 
In general, fair value of securities is based upon quoted market prices, where available (Level 1 inputs). If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon market prices determined by an outside, independent entity that primarily uses as inputs observable market-based parameters (Level 2 inputs). Fair value of loans held for sale is based upon internally developed models that primarily use as inputs observable market-based parameters. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. These adjustments may include amounts to reflect counterparty credit quality and the Company’s creditworthiness, among other things, as well as unobservable parameters (Level 3 inputs). Any such valuation adjustments are applied consistently over time. The Company’s valuation methodologies may produce a fair value calculation that may not be
 
 
PAGE 103

 
 
indicative of net realizable value or reflective of future fair values. While management believes the Company’s valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with those of other mar­ket participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.
 
Securities available for sale. Securities classified as available for sale are generally reported at fair value utilizing Level 1 and Level 2 inputs. Investments in fixed income securities, exclusive of preferred stock and mortgage-backed securities, are valued based on evaluations provided by Interactive Data Corporation (“IDC”), a leading global provider of market data information. IDC evaluations represent an exit price or their opinion as to what a buyer would pay for a security, typically in an institutional round lot position in a current sale. IDC seeks to utilize market data and observations in its evaluation service, and gives priority to observable benchmark yields and reported trades. IDC utilizes evaluated pricing techniques that vary by asset class and incorporate available market information; because many fixed income securities do not trade on a daily basis, IDC applies available information through processes such as benchmark curves, benchmarking of similar securities, sector groupings and matrix pricing. Model processes such as option-adjusted spread models are used to value securities that have prepayment features. Substantially all securities available for sale evaluated in this manner are deemed to be Level 2 valuations.
 
For mortgage-backed securities issued by U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises, management considers dealer indicative bids in the valuation process. Indicative bids are estimates of value and do not necessarily represent the price at which the dealer would be willing to transact. Such bids are compared to IDC-evaluated prices for reasonableness as well as consistency with observable market conditions. All mortgage-backed securities are deemed to be valued based on Level 2 inputs.
 
Publicly traded common and preferred stocks are valued by reference to the market closing price (last trade) on the measurement date (Level 1 inputs). In the unlikely event that no trade occurred on the measurement date, reference would be made to an indicative bid or the last trade most proximate to the measurement date (Level 2 inputs).
 
The following table summarizes financial assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value. There were no financial liabilities measured at fair value.
 
   
Level 1 Inputs
   
Level 2 Inputs
   
Level 3 Inputs
     
Total
Fair Value
 
December 31, 2012
                         
Securities available for sale:
                         
U.S. Treasury securities
  $ 6,386     $     $    
  6,386
 
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                               
Residential mortgage-backed securities
          25,006              25,006  
Agency notes
          1,231              1,231  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
          26,237              26,237  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
          17,923              17,923  
Single-issuer, trust preferred securities
    38,885                    38,885  
Other preferred securities
    11,953                    11,953  
Corporate debt securities
          174,418              174,418  
Equity and other securities
    21,035                    21,035  
Total marketable securities
  $ 78,259     $ 218,578     $     $ 296,837  
 
                                 
December 31, 2011
                               
Securities available for sale:
                               
Obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
                               
Residential mortgage-backed securities
  $     $ 29,752     $    
$
 29,752  
Agency notes
          1,237             1,237  
Total obligations of U.S. government corporations and government-sponsored enterprises
          30,989             30,989  
Obligations of state and political institutions—New York bank qualified
          22,777             22,777  
Single-issuer, trust preferred securities
    27,059                   27,059  
Corporate debt securities
          173,307             173,307  
Equity and other securities
    15,882                   15,882  
Total marketable securities
  $ 42,941     $ 227,073     $     $ 270,014  

 
PAGE 104

 
 
Certain financial assets, such as collateral-dependent impaired loans are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment). The following table summarizes the period end fair value of financial assets, based on significant unobservable (Level 3) inputs, measured on a non-recurring basis:
 
   
December 31,
2012
   
December 31,
2011
 
Impaired loans
           
 Commercial and industrial
  $     $ 1,298  
 Commercial real estate
    395       2,011  
Other real estate owned, net
    1,452       1,929  
 
Impaired loans. At the time a loan is considered impaired, it is valued at the lower of cost or fair value. Impaired loans carried at fair value may receive specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses. For collateral dependent loans, fair value is commonly based on recent real estate appraisals. These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value. Impaired loans are evaluated on a quarterly basis for additional impairment and adjusted accordingly.
 
Other real estate owned. Assets acquired through or instead of loan foreclosure are initially recorded at fair value less costs to sell when acquired, establishing a new cost basis. These assets are subsequently accounted for at lower of cost or fair value less estimated costs to sell. Fair values are generally based on third-party appraisals of the property utilizing a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach. Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available. Such adjustments typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value. In cases where the carrying amount exceeds the fair value, less costs to sell, an impairment loss is recognized.
 
Impaired loans that are measured for impairment using the fair value of the collateral for collateral dependent loans, had a principal balance of $0.7 million, with a valuation allowance of $0.3 million at December 31, 2012. There was no additional provision for loan losses for the year ended December 31, 2012. At December 31, 2011, impaired loans had a principal balance of $4.5 million, with a valuation allowance of $1.2 million, resulting in an additional provision for loan losses of $31 thousand for the year ended December 31, 2011.
 
Other real estate owned measured at fair value less costs to sell had a net carrying amount of $1.5 million, which is made up of the outstanding balance of $1.5 million, net of a valuation allowance of $-0- million. For the year ended December 31, 2012, $-0- million of other real estate owned was written down through a charge to noninterest expense. At December 31, 2011, other real estate owned had a net carrying amount of $1.9 million, made up of the outstanding balance of $1.9 million, net of a valuation allowance of $-0- thousand. For the year ended December 31, 2011, $-0- million of other real estate owned was written down through a charge to noninterest expense.
 
For those financial instruments that are not recorded at fair value in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, but are measured at fair value for disclosure purposes, management follows the same fair value measurement principles and guidance as for instruments recorded at fair value.
 
Much of the information used to arrive at “fair value” is highly subjective and judgmental in nature and therefore the results may not be precise. The subjective factors include, among other things, estimated cash flows, risk characteristics, credit quality and interest rates, all of which are subject to change. With the exception of investment securities and certain long-term debt, the Company’s financial instruments are not readily marketable and market prices do not exist. Since negotiated prices for the instruments that are not readily marketable depend greatly on the motivation of the buyer and seller, the amounts that will actually be realized or paid per settlement or maturity of these instruments could be significantly different.
 
 
PAGE 105

 
 
In particular, fair value estimates are made at a point in time, based on relevant market data as well as the best information available about the financial instrument. Illiquid credit markets have resulted in inactive markets for certain of the Company’s financial instruments. As a result, there is no or limited observable market data for these assets and liabilities. Fair value estimates for financial instruments for which no or limited observable market data is available are based on our judgments regarding current economic conditions, liquidity discounts, currency, credit, and interest rate risks, loss experience and other factors, all of which are Level 3 inputs as discussed above. These estimates involve significant judgments and uncertainties and cannot be substantiated by comparison to quoted prices in active markets and cannot be determined with precision. As a result, such calculated fair value estimates may not be realizable in a current sale or immediate settlement of the instrument. In addition, there are inherent uncertainties in any fair value measurement tech­nique, and changes in the underlying assumptions used in the fair value measurement technique, including discount rates, liquidity risks, and estimates of future cash flows, could ­significantly affect these fair value estimates.
 
A description of the methods, factors and significant assumptions utilized in estimating the fair values for significant categories of financial instruments follows:
 
Financial Instruments with Carrying Amounts Equal to Fair Value
The carrying amounts for cash and due from banks, interest-bearing deposits with other banks, accrued interest receivable, Federal funds purchased, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, commercial paper, other short-term borrowings, and accrued interest payable, as a result of their short-term nature, are considered to approximate fair value.
 
Investment Securities
The methods, factors and significant assumptions used to estimate fair values of all securities are described more fully beginning on page 103.
 
Loans, Net
The fair value of loans held in portfolio which reprice within 90 days reflecting changes in the base rate approximate their carrying amount. For other loans held in portfolio, the fair value is calculated based on discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality and for similar maturities. These calculations have been adjusted for credit risk based on the Company’s historical credit loss experience.
 
The fair value for secured nonaccrual loans is the value of the underlying collateral which is sufficient to repay each loan. For other nonaccrual loans, the fair value represents book value less a credit risk adjustment based on the Company’s historical credit loss experience.
 
The methods utilized to estimate the fair value of loans do not necessarily represent an exit price.
 
Deposits
FASB Codification Topic 825: Financial Instruments requires that the fair value of demand, savings, NOW (Negotiable Order of Withdrawal) and certain money market deposits be equal to their carrying amount. The Company believes that the fair value of these deposits, including the value of deposit relationships, is greater than that prescribed by FASB Codification Topic 825.
 
For other types of deposits with fixed maturities, fair value has been estimated based upon interest rates currently being offered on deposits with similar characteristics and maturities.
 
Advances—FHLB and Long-Term Borrowings
For advances—FHLB and long-term borrowings, the fair value is calculated based on discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being quoted for debt with similar characteristics and maturities.
 
Commitments to Extend Credit, Standby Letters of Credit and Financial Guarantees
The fees received for the issuance of commitments to extend credit, standby letters of credit, and financial guarantees, are considered to approximate fair value. Due to the uncertainty involved in attempting to assess the likelihood and timing of a commitment being drawn upon, coupled with the lack of an established market and the wide diversity of fee structures, the Company does not believe it is meaningful to provide an estimate of fair value that differs from the amount of consideration received.
 
 
PAGE 106

 
 
The following is a summary of the carrying amounts and fair values of the Company’s financial assets and liabilities. There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 during 2012 or 2011.
 
   
Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2012
 
   
Carrying
Value
   
 
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
 
Level 3
   
Total
 
FINANCIAL ASSETS
                             
Cash and due from banks
  $ 38,944     $ 38,944     $     $     $ 38,944  
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    112,886       112,886                   112,886  
Investment securities
    683,245       78,259       621,796             700,055  
Loans, net
    1,748,643                   1,762,431       1,762,431  
Accrued interest receivable
    6,853       520       4,193       2,140       6,853  
FINANCIAL LIABILITIES
                                       
Demand, NOW, savings and money market deposits
    1,626,043       1,626,043                   1,626,043  
Time deposits
    642,041             643,625             643,625  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    32,950       32,950                   32,950  
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    15,345       15,345                   15,345  
Accrued interest payable
    649       105       544             649  
Advances—FHLB and long-term borrowings
    127,039       100,000       1,275       27,211       128,486  

   
Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2011
 
   
Carrying
Value
   
 
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
 
Level 3
   
Total
 
FINANCIAL ASSETS
                             
Cash and due from banks
  $ 31,046     $ 31,046     $     $     $ 31,046  
Interest-bearing deposits with other banks
    126,448       126,448                   126,448  
Investment securities
    677,871       42,941       652,848             695,789  
Loans, net
    1,496,652                   1,505,005       1,505,005  
Accrued interest receivable
    6,838       377       4,732       1,729       6,838  
FINANCIAL LIABILITIES
                                       
Demand, NOW, savings and money market deposits
    1,331,223       1,331,223                   1,331,223  
Time deposits
    657,848             659,439             659,439  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
    52,313       52,313                   52,313  
Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings
    13,485       13,485                   13,485  
Accrued interest payable
    1,064       135       929             1,064  
Advances—FHLB and long-term borrowings
    148,507       100,000       22,886       26,170       149,056  
 
 
PAGE 107

 
 
NOTE 21.
CAPITAL MATTERS
 
The Company and the bank are subject to risk-based capital regulations which quantitatively measure capital against risk-weighted assets, including certain off-balance sheet items. These regulations define the elements of the Tier 1 and Tier 2 components of Total Capital and establish minimum ratios of 4% for Tier 1 capital and 8% for Total Capital for capital adequacy purposes. Sup­ple­menting these regulations is a leverage requirement. This requirement establishes a minimum leverage ratio (at least 3% or 4%, depending upon an institution’s regulatory status), which is calculated by dividing Tier 1 capital by adjusted quarterly average assets (after deducting goodwill). In addition, the bank is subject to the provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”) which imposes a number of mandatory supervisory measures. Among other matters, FDICIA established five capital categories ranging from “well capitalized” to “critically undercapitalized.” Such classifications are used by regulatory agencies to determine a bank’s deposit insurance premium, approval of applications authorizing institutions to increase their asset size or otherwise expand business activities or acquire other institutions. Under FDICIA a “well capitalized” bank must maintain minimum leverage, Tier 1 and Total Capital ratios of 5%, 6% and 10%, respectively. The Federal Reserve Board applies comparable tests for holding companies such as the Company. At December 31, 2012, management believes that the Company and the bank exceeded the requirements for “well capitalized” institutions under the tests pursuant to FDICIA and of the Federal Reserve Board.
 
The following tables present information regarding the Company’s and the bank’s regulatory capital ratios:
 
   
Actual
   
Minimum For Capital Adequacy
   
To Be Well Capitalized
 
As of December 31, 2012
 
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
   
Ratio
   
Amount
   
Ratio
 
Total Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):
                                   
The Company
  $ 268,866       12.58 %   $ 171,026       8.00 %   $ 213,782       10.00 %
The bank
    261,760       12.37       169,309       8.00       211,637       10.00  
Tier 1 Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):
                                               
The Company
    245,533       11.49       85,513       4.00       128,269       6.00  
The bank
    238,428       11.27       84,655       4.00       126,982       6.00  
Tier 1 Leverage Capital (to Average Assets):
                                               
The Company
    245,533       9.14       107,400       4.00       134,251       5.00  
The bank
    238,428       8.93       106,823       4.00       133,529       5.00  
As of December 31, 2011
                                               
Total Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):
                                               
The Company
  $ 256,526       13.71 %   $ 149,738       8.00 %   $ 187,173       10.00 %
The bank
    234,737       12.63       148,732       8.00       185,915       10.00  
Tier 1 Capital (to Risk-Weighted Assets):
                                               
The Company
    235,947       12.61       74,869       4.00       112,304       6.00  
The bank
    214,159       11.52       77,366       4.00       111,549       6.00  
Tier 1 Leverage Capital (to Average Assets):
                                               
The Company
    235,947       9.02       104,593       4.00       130,741       5.00  
The bank
    214,159       8.30       103,148       4.00       128,935       5.00  
 
 
PAGE 108

 
 
NOTE 22.
PARENT COMPANY
 
CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS
December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
 
ASSETS
           
Cash and due from banks—
           
  Banking subsidiary
  $ 3,021     $ 20,870  
  Other banks
    4       13  
Interest-bearing deposits—banking subsidiary
    3,069       1,244  
Securities available for sale (at fair value)
    11,564       8,571  
Loans, net of unearned discount
    10,772       10,127  
Investment in subsidiaries—
               
  Banking subsidiary (including goodwill of $22,901 in 2012 and 2011)
    248,352       226,403  
  Other subsidiaries
    2,202       2,179  
Cash surrender value of life insurance policies
    4,760       4,609  
Other assets
    17,531       16,728  
    $ 301,275     $ 290,744  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Commercial paper (see Note 8)
  $ 15,345     $ 13,485  
Due to subsidiaries—
               
  Other subsidiaries
    992       992  
Accrued expenses and other liabilities
    31,074       29,672  
Junior subordinated debt (see Note 10)
    25,774       25,774  
Shareholders’ equity
    228,090       220,821  
    $ 301,275     $ 290,744  
 
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
INCOME
                 
Dividends and interest from—
                 
  Banking subsidiary
  $ 1     $ 1     $ 2  
  Loans
    120       92       208  
  Securities available for sale
    115       249       342  
Other income
    56       140       155  
    Total income
    292       482       707  
EXPENSE
                       
Interest expense
    2,187       2,186       2,189  
Other expenses
    3,616       2,937       3,373  
  Total expense
    5,803       5,123       5,562  
Loss before income taxes and equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
    (5,511 )     (4,641 )     (4,855 )
Benefit for income taxes
    (1,652 )     (1,313 )     (1,147 )
Loss before equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
    (3,859 )     (3,328 )     (3,708 )
Equity in undistributed net income of—
                       
  Banking subsidiary
    23,852       20,905       10,713  
  Other subsidiaries
    23       19       21  
Net income
  $ 20,016     $ 17,596     $ 7,026  
 
 
PAGE 109

 
 
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

Years Ended December 31,
 
2012
   
2011
   
2010
 
OPERATING ACTIVITIES
                 
  Net income
  $ 20,016     $ 17,596     $ 7,026  
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used in operating activities:
                       
  Increase in accrued expenses and other liabilities
    1,402       2,414       3,246  
  Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
    (23,875 )     (20,924 )     (10,734 )
  Security gains
                (15 )
  Increase in other assets
    (954 )     (1,377 )     (4,415 )
  Other, net
    347       (1,383 )     1,028  
   Net cash used in operating activities
    (3,064 )     (3,674 )     (3,864 )
INVESTING ACTIVITIES
                       
  Net (increase) decrease in interest-bearing deposits—banking subsidiary
    (1,825 )     2,199       24,498  
  Purchase of securities available for sale
    (30,543 )     (109,991 )     (62,495 )
  (Increase) Decrease in loans
    (645 )     5,243       (209 )
  Proceeds from sales of securities available for sale
                2,054  
  Proceeds from maturities and redemptions of securities available for sale
    27,491       109,250       54,318  
  Investment in subsidiaries—banking subsidiary
                (31,500 )
  Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities
    (5,522 )     6,701       (13,334 )
FINANCING ACTIVITIES
                       
  Net increase (decrease) in commercial paper
    1,860       (903 )     (2,909 )
  Cash dividends paid on common shares
    (11,132 )     (11,122 )     (8,873 )
  Cash dividends paid on preferred shares
          (945 )     (2,100 )
  Proceeds from exercise of stock options
                403  
  Net proceeds from issuance of common shares
          36,454       64,881  
  Net redemption of preferred stock and common stock warrants
          (42,945 )      
  Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities
    (9,272 )     (19,461 )     51,402  
Net (decrease) increase in cash and due from banks
    (17,858 )     (16,434 )     34,204  
Cash and due from banks—beginning of year
    20,883       37,317       3,113  
Cash and due from banks—end of year
  $ 3,025     $ 20,883     $ 37,317  
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:
                       
  Interest paid
  $ 2,187     $ 2,187     $ 2,174  
  Income taxes paid
    7,479       5,744       3,994  
 
 
PAGE 110

 
 
NOTE 23.
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES
 
Total rental expenses under cancelable and noncancelable leases for premises and equipment were $5.9 million, $6.2 million and $5.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively, which are net of rental income for a sublease of $174 thousand, $213 thousand and $218 thousand for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
The future minimum rental commitments as of December 31, 2012 under noncancelable leases follow:
 
Year(s)
 
Rental
Commitments
 
2013
  $ 4,513  
2014
    4,910  
2015
    4,683  
2016
    3,956  
2017
    3,691  
2018 and thereafter
    19,274  
Total
  $ 41,027  
 
Certain leases included above have escalation clauses and/or provide that the Company pay maintenance, electric, taxes and other operating expenses applicable to the leased property.
 
In the normal course of business, there are various commitments and contingent liabilities outstanding which are properly not recorded on the balance sheet. Management does not anticipate that losses, if any, as a result of these transactions would materially affect the financial position of the Company.
 
Loan commitments, approximately 90% of which have an original maturity of one year or less, were approximately $179.2 million as of December 31, 2012. These commitments are agreements to lend to a customer as long as the conditions established in the contract are met. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements because some of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon. The bank evaluates each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary, by the bank upon extension of credit is based on management’s credit evaluation of the borrower. Collateral held varies but may include cash, U.S. Treasury and other marketable securities, accounts receivable, inventory and property, plant and equipment.
 
Standby letters of credit and financial guarantees, substantially all of which are within the scope of FASB Codification Topic 460: Guarantees, are written conditional commitments issued by the bank to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. At December 31, 2012, these commitments totaled $28.7 million of which $21.9 million expire within one year and $6.8 million within two years. Approximately 76% of the commitments are automatically renewable for a period of one year. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The bank holds cash or cash equivalents and marketable securities as collateral supporting those commitments for which collateral is deemed necessary. The extent of collateral held for those commitments at December 31, 2012 ranged from 0% to 100%; the average amount collateralized was approximately 77%.
 
Other commercial commitments principally consist of commercial letters of credit issued to our trade finance customers to finance the import of various merchandise. At December 31, 2012, these commitments totaled $40.0 million, of which $38.9 million expire within one year. The commercial documents are secured by the underlying merchandise. The majority of these letters of credit require cash payment before the release of documents.
 
In the normal course of business there are various legal proceedings pending against the Company. Management, after consulting with counsel, is of the opinion that there should be no material liability with respect to such proceedings, and accordingly no provision has been made in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
 
 
PAGE 111

 
 
NOTE 24.
QUARTERLY DATA (UNAUDITED)
 
2012 Quarter
 
Mar 31
   
Jun 30
   
Sept 30
   
Dec 31
 
Total interest income
  $ 25,220     $ 25,683     $ 26,510     $ 27,482  
Total interest expense
    2,813       2,781       2,718       2,669  
Net interest income
    22,407       22,902       23,792       24,813  
Provision for loan losses
    3,000       2,750       2,000       2,500  
Net securities gains
    879       329       282       323  
Noninterest income, excluding securities gains
    9,407       10,145       10,090       9,318  
Noninterest expenses
    23,044       23,625       24,342       24,873  
Income before income taxes
    6,649       7,001       7,822       7,081  
Provision for income taxes
    2,047       2,128       2,481       1,881  
Net income
    4,602       4,873       5,341       5,200  
Net income per average common share:
                               
 Basic
    0.15       0.16       0.17       0.17  
 Diluted
    0.15       0.16       0.17       0.17  
Common share closing price:
                               
High
    10.22       9.98       10.54       10.42  
Low
    8.53       8.69       9.05       8.62  
Quarter-end
    9.59       9.98       9.92       9.11  
 
2011 Quarter
 
Mar 31
   
Jun 30
   
Sept 30
   
Dec 31
 
Total interest income
  $ 23,184     $ 24,581     $ 25,924     $ 25,976  
Total interest expense
    3,325       3,193       3,307       3,162  
Net interest income
    19,859       21,388       22,617       22,814  
Provision for loan losses
    3,000       3,000       3,000       3,000  
Net securities gains
    1,124       505       605       257  
Noninterest income, excluding securities gains
    9,761       9,744       9,960       8,942  
Noninterest expenses
    22,326       23,298       23,621       24,539  
Income before income taxes
    5,418       5,339       6,561       4,474  
Provision (Benefit) for income taxes
    1,475       1,394       2,191       (864 )
Net income
    3,943       3,945       4,370       5,338  
Dividends on preferred shares and accretion
    644       1,430              
Net income available to common shareholders
    3,299       2,515       4,370       5,338  
Net income available to common shareholders, per average common share:
                               
 Basic
    0.12       0.08       0.14       0.17  
 Diluted
    0.12       0.08       0.14       0.17  
Common share closing price:
                               
High
    10.73       10.55       9.92       8.92  
Low
    9.48       8.78       7.05       6.67  
Quarter-end
    10.01       9.49       7.26       8.64  

 
PAGE 112

 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
 
 
To The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Sterling Bancorp
New York, New York
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Sterling Bancorp (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2012 and 2011, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012 and the consolidated statement of condition of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2012 and 2011. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2012 and 2011, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and the financial position of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2012 and 2011 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
 
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Sterling Bancorp’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 22, 2013 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.
 
 
/s/ Crowe Horwath LLP
Livingston, New Jersey
February 22, 2013
 
 
PAGE 113

 
 
ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
 
None.
 
ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
 
(a) Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
 
As required under the Exchange Act, the Company’s management, with the participation of the Com­pany’s principal executive and principal financial officers, evaluated the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act) as of the end of the period covered by this annual report on Form 10-K. Based on this evaluation the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that, as of December 31, 2012, the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in SEC rules and forms.
 
(b) Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting
The management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The Company’s internal control system is designed to provide reasonable assurance to the Company’s management and Board of Directors regarding the preparation and fair presentation of published financial statements.
 
Any system of internal control, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations, including the possibility that a control can be circumvented or overridden and misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected. Also, because of changes in conditions, internal control effectiveness may vary over time. Accordingly, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changed conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
The management of the Company assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012. In making its assessment of internal control over financial reporting, management used the criteria issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control—Integrated Framework. Based on this assessment, the Company’s management concluded that, as of December 31, 2012, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective.
 
Crowe Horwath LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the consolidated financial statements of the Company included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, has issued an attestation report on the effectiveness of the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012. The report, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012, is included in this Item under the heading “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” below.
 
 
PAGE 114

 

 
 
(c) Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
To The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Sterling Bancorp
New York, New York
 
We have audited Sterling Bancorp’s (the “Company”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Sterling Bancorp’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
 
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
In our opinion, Sterling Bancorp maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2012, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).
 
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of Sterling Bancorp as of December 31, 2012 and 2011 and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2012 and the consolidated statement of condition of Sterling National Bank as of December 31, 2012 and 2011 and our report dated February 22, 2013 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.


/s/ Crowe Horwath LLP
Livingston, New Jersey
February 22, 2013
 
 
PAGE 115

 
 
(d) Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
No change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act) occurred during the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2012 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
 
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION
 
None.
 
 
PAGE 116

 
 
PART III

 
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
 
Information regarding executive officers required by Item 401 of Regulation S-K is furnished in a separate disclosure beginning on page 27 at the end of Part I of this report. The other information required by Item 10 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act within 120 days after December 31, 2012 and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
The information required by Item 11 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act within 120 days after December 31, 2012 and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
 
See the information appearing in Note 16 of the Company’s consolidated financial statements beginning on page 94.
 
The following table provides information as of December 31, 2012, regarding securities issued to all of the Company’s employees under equity compensation plans that were in effect during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2012, and other equity compensation plan information.
 
EQUITY COMPENSATION PLAN INFORMATION
 
Plan Category
 
Number of Securities
to be Issued
upon Exercise of
Outstanding Options,
Warrants and Rights
(a)
   
Weighted-Average Exercise Price of Outstanding Options, Warrants and Rights
(b)
   
Number of Securities Remaining Available
for Future Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans (excluding
securities reflected
in column (a))
(c)
 
Equity Compensation Plans approved by security holders
    87,500     $ 17.99       839,144 *
Equity Compensation Plans not approved by security holders
                 
Total
    87,500     $ 17.99    
839,144
 
 
*
This plan expired in 2012 and no future awards may be made under it.
 
The other information required by Item 12 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act within 120 days after December 31, 2012 and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
 
The information required by Item 13 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act within 120 days after December 31, 2012 and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES
 
The information required by Item 14 will be in the parent company’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act within 120 days after December 31, 2012 and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
PAGE 117

 
 
PART IV
 
 
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
(a)  The documents filed as a part of this report are listed below:
 
1. Financial Statements Sterling Bancorp
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2012 and 2011
Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2012, 2011 and 2010
Sterling National Bank
Consolidated Statements of Condition as of December 31, 2012 and 2011
 
2. Financial Statement Schedules
None
 
3. Exhibits
3.
(i)
Restated Certificate of Incorporation filed with the State of New York Department of State on October 28, 2004 (Filed as Exhibit 3(i) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(ii)
Certificate of Amendment of Certificate of Incorporation filed with the New York Department of State on December 18, 2008. (Filed as Exhibit 3(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
  (iii)
By-Laws as amended through November 15, 2007 (Filed as Exhibit 3(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated November 15, 2007 and filed on November 19, 2007 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
4.
Pursuant to Regulation S-K, Item 601(b)(4) (iii)(A), no instrument which defines the rights of holders of long-term debt of the Registrant or any of its consolidated sub­sidiaries is filed herewith. Pursuant to this regulation, the Registrant hereby agrees to furnish a copy of any such instrument to the SEC upon request.
 
10.
(i)(A)*
Sterling Bancorp Stock Incentive Plan (Amended and Restated as of May 20, 2004) (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(i)(B)*
Form of Award Letter for Non-Employee Directors (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Reg­istrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(i)(C)*
Form of Award Letter for Officers (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(i)(D)*
Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Award (Filed as Exhibit 10(A) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated March 18, 2005 and filed on March 24, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(i)(E)*
Form of Award Letter for Officers (Filed as Exhibit 10(i)(E) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(i)(F)*
Amendment to Sterling Bancorp Stock Incentive Plan (Filed as Exhibit 10(i)(F) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(ii)(A)* 
Sterling Bancorp Key Executive Incentive Bonus Plan (Filed as Exhibit C to the Reg­is­trant’s definitive Proxy Statement, dated March 13, 2001, filed on March 16, 2001 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
* Constitutes a Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement
 
 
PAGE 118

 
 
 
(ii)(B)*
Amendment to Sterling Bancorp Key Executive Incentive Bonus Plan (Filed as Exhibit 10(ii)(B) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(A)*
Amended and Restated Employment Agreements dated March 22, 2002 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(i)(a) and 10(i)(b), respectively, to the Reg­istrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(B)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated February 26, 2003 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 3.10(xiv)(a) and 3.10(xiv)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(C)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated February 24, 2004 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(xv)(a) and 10(xv)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(D)* 
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 18, 2005 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(B) and 10(C), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated March 18, 2005 and filed on March 24, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(E)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 15, 2006 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(E)(a) and 10(iii)(E)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(F)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 15, 2007 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(F)(a) and 10(iii)(F)(b), respectively, tothe Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(G)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 13, 2008 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(G)(a) and 10(iii)(G)(b), respectively, tothe Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2007 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(H)*
Amendments dated December 29, 2008 to Employment Agreements (a) For Louis J. Cappelli and (b) For John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibit 10(iii)(H) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(I)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 12, 2009 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(I)(a) and 10(iii)(I)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(J)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 25, 2010 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(ii)(J)(a) and 10(iii)(J)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(K)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 8, 2011 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(K)(a) and 10(iii)(K)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iii)(L)*
Amendments to Employment Agreements dated March 2, 2012 for Louis J. Cappelli and John C. Millman (Filed as Exhibits 10(iii)(L)(a) and 10(iii)(L)(b), respectively, to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(A)*
Form of Change of Control Severance Agree­ment entered into May 21, 1999 between the Registrant and each of six executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 1999 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
* Constitutes a Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement
 
 
PAGE 119

 

 
(iv)(B)*
Amendment to Form of Change of Control Severance Agreement dated February 6, 2002 entered into between the Registrant and each of four executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(ii) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(C)*
Form of Change of Control Severance Agree­ment dated April 3, 2002 entered into between the Registrant and one executive (Filed as Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2002 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(D)*
Form of Change of Control Severance Agree­ment dated June 8, 2004 entered into between the Registrant and one executive (Filed as Exhibit 10(i) to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2004 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(E)*
Form of Change of Control Severance and Retention Agreement, dated as of November 7, 2006, entered into between the Registrant and one officer (Filed as Exhibit 10 to the Registrant’s Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(F)*
Form of Change of Control Severance and Retention Agreement, dated as of September 7, 2006, entered into between the Registrant and one officer (Filed as Exhibit 10(iv)(F) to the Registrant’s Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(G)*
Form of Amendment dated December 29, 2008 to Form of Change in Control Severance Agreement between the Registrant and each of three executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(iv)(G) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
(iv)(H)*
Form of Amendment dated December 29, 2008 to Form of Change in Control Severance and Retention Agreement between the Registrant and each of six executives (Filed as Exhibit 10(iv)(H) to the Registrant’s Form 8-K dated December 29, 2008 and filed on January 5, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
11.
Statement re: Computation of Per Share Earnings.
 
12.
Statement re: Computation of Ratios.
 
21.
Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
 
23.
Consent of Crowe Horwath LLP Independent Regis­tered Public Accounting Firm.
 
31.1 
Certification of the CEO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-14(a).
 
31.2 
Certification of the CFO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13a-14(a).
 
32.1 
Certification of the CEO required by Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the U.S. Code. (Pursuant to Item 601(b)(32)(ii) of Regulation S-K under the Exchange Act, the certification filed under this Exhibit shall be deemed “furnished” and not “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act and shall not be otherwise subject to the liability of that section).
 
32.2 
Certification of the CFO required by Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the U.S. Code. (Pursuant to Item 601(b)(32)(ii) of Regulation S-K under the Exchange Act, the certification filed under this Exhibit shall be deemed “furnished” and not “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act and shall not be otherwise subject to the liability of that section).
 
101.INS**
XBRL Instance Document
 
101.SCH** 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema
 
101.CAL**
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Label Linkbase
 
101.LAB**
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase
 
101.PRE**
XBRL Taxonomy Presentation Linkbase
 
101.DEF**
XBRL Taxonomy Definition Linkbase
 
*
Constitutes a Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement
**
As provided in Rule 406T of Regulation S-T, this information is furnished and not filed for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1993 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
 
 
PAGE 120

 
 
SIGNATURES
 
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
STERLING BANCORP
 
                                                   /s/ Louis J. Cappelli                                                  
Louis J. Cappelli, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
        February 22, 2013       
Date

 
                      /s/ John W. Tietjen                     
John W. Tietjen, Executive Vice President
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
 
        February 22, 2013       
Date
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated:
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ Louis J. Cappelli                   
(Date)
 
Louis J. Cappelli
Director, Chairman and
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ John W. Tietjen                    
(Date)
 
John W. Tietjen
Executive Vice President
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ John C. Millman                   
(Date)
 
John C. Millman
Director
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ Henry J. Humphreys                   
(Date)
 
Henry J. Humphreys
Director
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ Joseph M. Adamko                   
(Date)
 
Joseph M. Adamko
Director
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ Robert W. Lazar                   
(Date)
 
Robert W. Lazar
Director
 
February 22, 2013
 
                    /s/ Eugene T. Rossides                   
(Date)
 
Eugene T. Rossides
Director
 

 
PAGE 121

 
 
EXHIBIT INDEX
 

11. 
Statement re: Computation of Per Share Earnings.
 
12. 
Statement re: Computation of Ratios.
 
21. 
Subsidiaries of the Registrant.
 
23. 
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.
 
31.1 
Certification of the CEO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13A–14(A).
 
31.2 
Certification of the CFO pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 13A–14(A).
 
32.1* 
Certification of the CEO required by Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the U.S. Code.
 
32.2* 
Certification of the CFO required by Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the U.S. Code.
 
101.INS*
XBRL Instance Document
 
101.SCH*
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema
 
101.CAL*
XBRL  Taxonomy Extension Calculation Label Linkbase
 
101.LAB*
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase
 
101.PRE*
XBRL Taxonomy Presentation Linkbase
 
101.DEF*
XBRL Taxonomy Definition Linkbase
 
* This information is furnished and not filed for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1993 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.